blob: 3ac4d133fe33917c7b63d624280c03da56d16ee4 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "Sema.h"
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +000015#include "SemaInit.h"
John McCall5cebab12009-11-18 07:57:50 +000016#include "Lookup.h"
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +000017#include "AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Chris Lattnercb6a3822006-11-10 06:20:45 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbar6e8aa532008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000022#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +000023#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Naroff021ca182008-05-29 21:12:08 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000025#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000026#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +000027#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000028#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000029#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
30#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +000031#include "clang/Parse/DeclSpec.h"
Chris Lattner07d754a2008-10-26 23:43:26 +000032#include "clang/Parse/Designator.h"
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +000033#include "clang/Parse/Scope.h"
Douglas Gregorb53edfb2009-11-10 19:49:08 +000034#include "clang/Parse/Template.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000035using namespace clang;
36
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +000037
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000038/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
39/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
40///
41/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
42/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
43/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
44/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
45/// function is being used.
46///
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000047/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
48/// decls.
49///
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000050/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
51/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000052///
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000053bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000054 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000055 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000056 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000057 }
58
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000059 // See if the decl is unavailable
60 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
61 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
62 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
63 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +000064
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000065 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000066 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000067 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
68 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
69 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
70 return true;
71 }
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000072 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000073
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000074 return false;
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000075}
76
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000077/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000078/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000079/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
80///
81void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000082 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000083 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000084 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000085 return;
Douglas Gregorc298ffc2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000086
87 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
88 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000089 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
90 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000091
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000092 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
93 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000094 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +000095 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
96 int isMethod = 0;
97 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
98 // skip over named parameters.
99 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
100 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
101 if (nullPos)
102 --nullPos;
103 else
104 ++i;
105 }
106 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
107 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000108 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000109 // skip over named parameters.
110 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
111 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
112 if (nullPos)
113 --nullPos;
114 else
115 ++i;
116 }
117 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000118 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000119 // block or function pointer call.
120 QualType Ty = V->getType();
121 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000122 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000123 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
124 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000125 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
126 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
127 unsigned k;
128 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
129 if (nullPos)
130 --nullPos;
131 else
132 ++i;
133 }
134 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
135 }
136 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
137 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000138 } else
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000139 return;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000140 } else
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000141 return;
142
143 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000144 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000145 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000146 return;
147 }
148 int sentinel = i;
149 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
150 --sentinelPos;
151 ++i;
152 }
153 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
154 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000155 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000156 return;
157 }
158 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
159 ++i;
160 ++sentinel;
161 }
162 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000163 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
164 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
165 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
166 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isPointerType() &&
167 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
168 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
169 return;
170
171 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
172 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
173
174 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
175 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000176}
177
Douglas Gregor87f95b02009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000178SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
179 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
180 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
181}
182
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000183//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
184// Standard Promotions and Conversions
185//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
186
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000187/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
188void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
189 QualType Ty = E->getType();
190 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
191
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000192 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000193 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
Anders Carlsson6904f642009-09-01 20:37:18 +0000194 CastExpr::CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000195 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
196 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
197 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
198 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
199 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
200 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
201 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9321c742008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000202 //
203 // C++ 4.2p1:
204 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
205 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
206 //
207 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
208 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson8fc489d2009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000209 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
210 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000211 }
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000212}
213
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000214void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
215 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000216
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000217 QualType Ty = E->getType();
218 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
219 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
220 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
221 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
222 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
223 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
224 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
225 // rvalue is T
226 //
227 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000228 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
229 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000230 // type of the lvalue.
231 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
232 }
233}
234
235
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000236/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000237/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000238/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
239/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
240/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
241Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
242 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
243 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000244
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000245 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
246 //
247 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
248 // unsigned int may be used:
249 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
250 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
251 // and unsigned int.
252 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
253 //
254 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
255 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
256 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
257 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000258 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
259 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000260 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000261 return Expr;
262 }
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000263 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000264 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000265 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000266 return Expr;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000267 }
268
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000269 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000270 return Expr;
271}
272
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000273/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000274/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000275/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
276void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
277 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
278 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000279
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000280 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000281 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>())
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000282 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000283 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
284 CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000285
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000286 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
287}
288
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000289/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
290/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
291/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
292/// completely illegal.
293bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT) {
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000294 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000295
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000296 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCInterfaceType() &&
297 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
298 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
299 << Expr->getType() << CT))
300 return true;
Douglas Gregor7ca84af2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000301
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000302 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000303 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000304 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
305 << Expr->getType() << CT))
306 return true;
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000307
308 return false;
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000309}
310
311
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000312/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
313/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000314/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000315/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
316/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
317/// GCC.
318QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
319 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000320 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000321 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000322
323 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000324
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000325 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000326 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000327 QualType lhs =
328 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000329 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000330 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000331
332 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
333 if (lhs == rhs)
334 return lhs;
335
336 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
337 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
338 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
339 return lhs;
340
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000341 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000342 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000343 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
344 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000345 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000346 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
347 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
348
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000349 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000350 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000351 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
352 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000353 return destType;
354}
355
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000356//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
357// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
358//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
359
360
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000361/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000362/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
363/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
364/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
365/// string.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000366///
367Action::OwningExprResult
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000368Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000369 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
370
Chris Lattner8a24e582009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000371 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Steve Naroff4f88b312007-03-13 22:37:02 +0000372 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000373 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000374
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +0000375 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000376 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
377 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000378
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000379 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscbad7252008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000380 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000381 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000382
383 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
John McCallc33dec32010-03-15 10:54:44 +0000384 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings )
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000385 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000386
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000387 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
388 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
389 // strings.
390 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerd42c29f2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000391 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000392 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000393
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000394 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000395 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
Chris Lattnerf83b5af2009-02-18 06:40:38 +0000396 Literal.GetStringLength(),
397 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
398 &StringTokLocs[0],
399 StringTokLocs.size()));
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000400}
401
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000402/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
403/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
404/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
405/// for values inside the block or for globals).
406///
Douglas Gregor4f13beb2010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000407/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000408/// up-to-date.
409///
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000410static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000411 ValueDecl *VD) {
412 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
413 // we wanted to.
414 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
415 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000416
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000417 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
418 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
419 return false;
420
421 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
422 // snapshot it.
423 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
424 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000425 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
426 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000427
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000428 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
429 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
430
431 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
432 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
433 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
434 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000435 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
436 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000437
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000438 if (!NextBlock)
439 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000440
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000441 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
442 // having a reference outside it.
443 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
444 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000445
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000446 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
447 // a snapshot as well.
448 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
449 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000450
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000451 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000452}
453
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000454
455
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +0000456/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000457Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallce546572009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000458Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000459 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000460 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
461 Diag(Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000462 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000463 << D->getDeclName();
464 return ExprError();
465 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000466
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000467 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000468 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
469 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
470 // visible.
471 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000472 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
473 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000474 Diag(Loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000475 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000476 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000477 << D->getIdentifier();
478 return ExprError();
479 }
480 }
481 }
482 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000483
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000484 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, D);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000485
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000486 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
487 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
488 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Douglas Gregored6c7442009-11-23 11:41:28 +0000489 D, Loc, Ty));
Douglas Gregorc7acfdf2009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000490}
491
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000492/// getObjectForAnonymousRecordDecl - Retrieve the (unnamed) field or
493/// variable corresponding to the anonymous union or struct whose type
494/// is Record.
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +0000495static Decl *getObjectForAnonymousRecordDecl(ASTContext &Context,
496 RecordDecl *Record) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000497 assert(Record->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000498 "Record must be an anonymous struct or union!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000499
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +0000500 // FIXME: Once Decls are directly linked together, this will be an O(1)
501 // operation rather than a slow walk through DeclContext's vector (which
502 // itself will be eliminated). DeclGroups might make this even better.
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000503 DeclContext *Ctx = Record->getDeclContext();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000504 for (DeclContext::decl_iterator D = Ctx->decls_begin(),
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +0000505 DEnd = Ctx->decls_end();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000506 D != DEnd; ++D) {
507 if (*D == Record) {
508 // The object for the anonymous struct/union directly
509 // follows its type in the list of declarations.
510 ++D;
511 assert(D != DEnd && "Missing object for anonymous record");
Douglas Gregor6e6ad602009-01-20 01:17:11 +0000512 assert(!cast<NamedDecl>(*D)->getDeclName() && "Decl should be unnamed");
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000513 return *D;
514 }
515 }
516
517 assert(false && "Missing object for anonymous record");
518 return 0;
519}
520
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000521/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
522/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
523/// actual member.
524///
525/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
526/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
527/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
528/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
529/// we found.
530///
531/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
532/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
533/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
534VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
535 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000536 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
537 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
538 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
539
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000540 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000541 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
542 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
543 do {
544 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +0000545 Decl *AnonObject = getObjectForAnonymousRecordDecl(Context, Record);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000546 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000547 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000548 else {
549 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
550 break;
551 }
552 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000553 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000554 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000555
556 return BaseObject;
557}
558
559Sema::OwningExprResult
560Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
561 FieldDecl *Field,
562 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
563 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
564 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000565 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000566 AnonFields);
567
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000568 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
569 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
570 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
571 // found via name lookup.
572 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000573 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000574 if (BaseObject) {
575 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
576 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +0000577 if (BaseObjectExpr) BaseObjectExpr->Destroy(Context);
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000578 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000579 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000580 SourceLocation());
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000581 BaseQuals
582 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000583 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
584 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
585 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
586 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
587 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000588 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000589 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
590 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
591 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000592 BaseQuals
593 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000594 } else {
595 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
596 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
597 // program our base object expression is "this".
598 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
599 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000600 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000601 = Context.getTagDeclType(
602 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
603 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000604 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000605 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
606 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
607 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor4b654412009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000608 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000609 MD->getThisType(Context),
610 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000611 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
612 }
613 } else {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000614 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
615 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000616 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000617 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000618 }
619
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000620 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000621 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
622 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000623 }
624
625 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
626 // anonymous struct/union.
627 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000628 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000629 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
630 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
631 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
632 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000633 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
634 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
635
636 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
637 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
638 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
639 ResultQuals.removeConst();
640
641 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
642 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
643
644 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
645 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
646
647 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
648 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
649 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
650
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000651 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000652 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000653 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000654 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
655 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000656 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000657 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000658 }
659
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000660 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000661}
662
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000663/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationName, its location, and
664/// possibly a list of template arguments.
665///
666/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
667/// DecomposeTemplateName.
668///
669/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
670/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
671/// some way.
672static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
673 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
674 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
675 DeclarationName &Name,
676 SourceLocation &NameLoc,
677 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
678 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
679 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
680 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
681
682 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
683 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
684 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
685 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
686 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
687
688 TemplateName TName =
689 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
690
691 Name = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName);
692 NameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
693 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
694 } else {
695 Name = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
696 NameLoc = Id.StartLocation;
697 TemplateArgs = 0;
698 }
699}
700
701/// Decompose the given template name into a list of lookup results.
702///
703/// The unqualified ID must name a non-dependent template, which can
704/// be more easily tested by checking whether DecomposeUnqualifiedId
705/// found template arguments.
706static void DecomposeTemplateName(LookupResult &R, const UnqualifiedId &Id) {
707 assert(Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId);
708 TemplateName TName =
709 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
710
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000711 if (TemplateDecl *TD = TName.getAsTemplateDecl())
712 R.addDecl(TD);
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +0000713 else if (OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = TName.getAsOverloadedTemplate())
714 for (OverloadedTemplateStorage::iterator I = OT->begin(), E = OT->end();
715 I != E; ++I)
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000716 R.addDecl(*I);
John McCalla9ee3252009-11-22 02:49:43 +0000717
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000718 R.resolveKind();
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +0000719}
720
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000721/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
722/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
723/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000724static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000725 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
726 return false;
727
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000728 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
729 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
730 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
731 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
732 if (!BaseRT) return false;
733
734 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000735 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000736 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
737 return false;
738 }
739
740 return true;
741}
742
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000743/// Determines whether we can lookup this id-expression now or whether
744/// we have to wait until template instantiation is complete.
745static bool IsDependentIdExpression(Sema &SemaRef, const CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000746 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000747
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000748 // If the qualifier scope isn't computable, it's definitely dependent.
749 if (!DC) return true;
750
751 // If the qualifier scope doesn't name a record, we can always look into it.
752 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) return false;
753
754 // We can't look into record types unless they're fully-formed.
755 if (!IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))) return true;
756
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000757 return false;
758}
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000759
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000760/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
761/// the prospective base classes.
762static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
763 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
764 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000765 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000766 return false;
767
Douglas Gregor0a5a2212010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000768 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000769 if (!RD) return false;
770 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
771
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000772 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
773 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
774 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
775 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
776 if (!BaseRT) return false;
777
778 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000779 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
780 return false;
781 }
782
783 return true;
784}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000785
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000786enum IMAKind {
787 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
788 IMA_Static,
789
790 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
791 IMA_Mixed,
792
793 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
794 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
795 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
796
797 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
798 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
799 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
800
801 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
802 IMA_Instance,
803
804 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
805 IMA_Unresolved,
806
807 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
808 /// context is not an instance method.
809 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
810
811 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
812 /// non-class context.
813 IMA_AnonymousMember,
814
815 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
816 /// context is not an instance method.
817 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
818
819 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
820 /// class.
821 IMA_Error_Unrelated
822};
823
824/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
825/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
826/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
827/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
828/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
829/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
830static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
831 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000832 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000833
834 bool isStaticContext =
835 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext) ||
836 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)->isStatic());
837
838 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
839 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
840
841 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
842 bool hasNonInstance = false;
843 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
844 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000845 NamedDecl *D = *I;
846 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000847 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
848
849 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
850 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
851 // that's a special case.
852 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
853 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
854 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
855 }
856 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
857 }
858 else
859 hasNonInstance = true;
860 }
861
862 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
863 // member reference.
864 if (Classes.empty())
865 return IMA_Static;
866
867 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
868 // an implicit member reference.
869 if (isStaticContext)
870 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
871
872 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
873 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
874 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
875 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
876 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)->getParent(),
877 Classes))
878 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
879
880 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
881}
882
883/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
884static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
885 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
886 const LookupResult &R) {
887 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
888 SourceRange Range(Loc);
889 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
890
891 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
892 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
893 if (MD->isStatic()) {
894 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
895 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
896 << Range << R.getLookupName();
897 return;
898 }
899 }
900
901 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
902 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
903 return;
904 }
905
906 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000907}
908
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000909/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
910///
911/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +0000912bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000913 LookupResult &R) {
914 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
915
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000916 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000917 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000918 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
919 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000920 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000921 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000922 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
923 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000924
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000925 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
926 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
927 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
928 // dependent name.
929 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty()? CurContext : 0;
930 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000931 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
932 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
933
934 if (!R.empty()) {
935 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
936 R.suppressDiagnostics();
937
938 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
939 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
940 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
941 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
942
943 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
944 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
945 // Actually quite difficult!
946 if (isInstance)
947 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +0000948 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000949 else
950 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
951
952 // Do we really want to note all of these?
953 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
954 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
955
956 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
957 return false;
958 }
959 }
960 }
961
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000962 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000963 DeclarationName Corrected;
964 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS))) {
965 if (!R.empty()) {
966 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
967 if (SS.isEmpty())
968 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
969 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
970 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
971 else
972 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
973 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
974 << SS.getRange()
975 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
976 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
977 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
978 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
979 << ND->getDeclName();
980
981 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
982 return false;
983 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000984
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000985 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
986 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
987 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
988 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
989 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
990 // to recover well anyway.
991 if (SS.isEmpty())
992 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
993 else
994 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
995 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
996 << SS.getRange();
997
998 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
999 return true;
1000 }
1001 } else {
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001002 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001003 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001004 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001005 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001006 else
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001007 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001008 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
1009 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001010 return true;
1011 }
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001012 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001013 }
1014
1015 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
1016 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
1017 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
1018 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1019 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1020 << SS.getRange();
1021 return true;
1022 }
1023
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001024 // Give up, we can't recover.
1025 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1026 return true;
1027}
1028
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001029Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001030 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001031 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1032 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1033 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
1034 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1035 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1036
1037 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregored8f2882009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001038 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001039
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001040 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001041
1042 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
1043 DeclarationName Name;
1044 SourceLocation NameLoc;
1045 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001046 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
1047 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001048
Douglas Gregor4ea80432008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001049 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001050
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001051 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1052 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001053 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1054 // (note: handled after lookup)
1055 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1056 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1057 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001058 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1059 // names a dependent type.
1060 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1061 // we need to handle these differently.
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001062 if ((Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1063 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) ||
1064 (SS.isSet() && IsDependentIdExpression(*this, SS))) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001065 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, Name, NameLoc,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00001066 isAddressOfOperand,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001067 TemplateArgs);
1068 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001069
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001070 // Perform the required lookup.
1071 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1072 if (TemplateArgs) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001073 // Just re-use the lookup done by isTemplateName.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001074 DecomposeTemplateName(R, Id);
Douglas Gregor9262f472010-04-27 18:19:34 +00001075
1076 // Re-derive the naming class.
1077 if (SS.isSet()) {
1078 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier
1079 = static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier *>(SS.getScopeRep());
1080 if (const Type *Ty = Qualifier->getAsType())
1081 if (CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
1082 R.setNamingClass(NamingClass);
1083 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001084 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001085 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
1086 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001087
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001088 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1089 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001090 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
1091 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001092 if (E.isInvalid())
1093 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001094
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001095 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1096 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Steve Naroffebf4cb42008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001097 }
Chris Lattner59a25942008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001098 }
Douglas Gregorf15f5d32009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001099
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001100 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1101 return ExprError();
1102
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001103 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1104 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001105 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001106
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001107 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Bill Wendling4073ed52007-02-13 01:51:42 +00001108 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001109 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1110 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1111 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1112 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1113 }
1114
1115 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1116 // call, diagnose the problem.
1117 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001118 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R))
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001119 return ExprError();
1120
1121 assert(!R.empty() &&
1122 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001123
1124 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1125 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001126 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001127 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1128 R.clear();
1129 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
1130 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1131 return move(E);
1132 }
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00001133 }
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001134 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001135
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001136 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1137 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1138
1139 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001140 // Warn about constructs like:
1141 // if (void *X = foo()) { ... } else { X }.
1142 // In the else block, the pointer is always false.
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001143 if (Var->isDeclaredInCondition() && Var->getType()->isScalarType()) {
1144 Scope *CheckS = S;
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001145 while (CheckS && CheckS->getControlParent()) {
Chris Lattnerdf742642010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001146 if ((CheckS->getFlags() & Scope::ElseScope) &&
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001147 CheckS->getControlParent()->isDeclScope(DeclPtrTy::make(Var))) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001148 ExprError(Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_value_always_zero)
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001149 << Var->getDeclName()
Chris Lattnerdf742642010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001150 << (Var->getType()->isPointerType() ? 2 :
1151 Var->getType()->isBooleanType() ? 1 : 0));
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001152 break;
1153 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001154
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001155 // Move to the parent of this scope.
1156 CheckS = CheckS->getParent();
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001157 }
1158 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001159 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001160 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1161 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1162 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1163 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1164 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1165 // type.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001166 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001167 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001168
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001169 QualType T = Func->getType();
1170 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001171 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001172 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001173 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001174 }
1175 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001176
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001177 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
1178 // C++ [expr.prim.general]p6:
1179 // Within the definition of a non-static member function, an
1180 // identifier that names a non-static member is transformed to a
1181 // class member access expression.
1182 // But note that &SomeClass::foo is grammatically distinct, even
1183 // though we don't parse it that way.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001184 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001185 bool isAbstractMemberPointer = (isAddressOfOperand && !SS.isEmpty());
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001186 if (!isAbstractMemberPointer)
1187 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001188 }
1189
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001190 if (TemplateArgs)
1191 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001192
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001193 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1194}
1195
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001196/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
1197Sema::OwningExprResult
1198Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1199 LookupResult &R,
1200 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1201 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1202 case IMA_Instance:
1203 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1204
1205 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1206 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1207 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1208 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1209
1210 case IMA_Mixed:
1211 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1212 case IMA_Unresolved:
1213 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1214
1215 case IMA_Static:
1216 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1217 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1218 if (TemplateArgs)
1219 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1220 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1221
1222 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1223 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1224 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1225 return ExprError();
1226 }
1227
1228 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1229 return ExprError();
1230}
1231
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001232/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1233/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1234/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1235/// this path.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001236Sema::OwningExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001237Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001238 DeclarationName Name,
1239 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1240 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001241 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001242 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, Name, NameLoc, 0);
1243
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001244 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001245 return ExprError();
1246
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001247 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1248 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1249
1250 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1251 return ExprError();
1252
1253 if (R.empty()) {
1254 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_no_member) << Name << DC << SS.getRange();
1255 return ExprError();
1256 }
1257
1258 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1259}
1260
1261/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1262/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1263/// additional lookup.
1264///
1265/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1266/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1267///
1268/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
1269Sema::OwningExprResult
1270Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnera36ec422010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001271 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001272 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001273 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001274
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001275 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1276 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1277 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1278 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1279 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1280
1281 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1282 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1283 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001284 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001285
1286 bool LookForIvars;
1287 if (Lookup.empty())
1288 LookForIvars = true;
1289 else if (IsClassMethod)
1290 LookForIvars = false;
1291 else
1292 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1293 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian45878032010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001294 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001295 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001296 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001297 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1298 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1299 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1300 if (IsClassMethod)
1301 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1302 << IV->getDeclName());
1303
1304 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1305 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1306 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1307 return ExprError();
1308
1309 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1310 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1311 return ExprError();
1312
1313 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1314 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1315 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1316 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1317
1318 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1319 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1320 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1321 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001322 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001323 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
1324 OwningExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
1325 SelfName, false, false);
1326 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1327 return Owned(new (Context)
1328 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1329 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1330 }
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001331 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001332 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001333 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001334 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1335 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1336 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1337 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1338 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1339 }
1340 }
1341
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001342 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1343 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1344 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1345 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1346 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1347 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1348 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1349 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1350 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1351 }
1352 }
1353 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001354 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1355 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001356}
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001357
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001358/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1359///
1360/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1361///
1362/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1363/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1364/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1365/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1366///
1367/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1368/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1369/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1370/// the class declaring the member.
1371///
1372/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1373/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1374/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001375bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001376Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1377 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001378 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001379 NamedDecl *Member) {
1380 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1381 if (!RD)
1382 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001383
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001384 QualType DestRecordType;
1385 QualType DestType;
1386 QualType FromRecordType;
1387 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1388 bool PointerConversions = false;
1389 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1390 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001391
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001392 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1393 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1394 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1395 PointerConversions = true;
1396 } else {
1397 DestType = DestRecordType;
1398 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001399 }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001400 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1401 if (Method->isStatic())
1402 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001403
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001404 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1405 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001406
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001407 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1408 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1409 PointerConversions = true;
1410 } else {
1411 FromRecordType = FromType;
1412 DestType = DestRecordType;
1413 }
1414 } else {
1415 // No conversion necessary.
1416 return false;
1417 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001418
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001419 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1420 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001421
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001422 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1423 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1424 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001425
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001426 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1427 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1428
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001429 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001430 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001431 // class name.
1432 //
1433 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1434 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1435 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1436 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1437 //
1438 // class Base { public: int x; };
1439 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1440 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1441 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1442 //
1443 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1444 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1445 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1446 // }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001447 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001448 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1449 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1450 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1451
1452 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1453
1454 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1455 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1456 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1457 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001458 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001459 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001460 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001461 return true;
1462
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001463 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001464 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001465 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001466 /*isLvalue=*/!PointerConversions, BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001467
1468 FromType = QType;
1469 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1470
1471 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1472 // we're done.
1473 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1474 return false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001475 }
1476 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001477
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001478 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001479
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001480 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1481 // down to the using declaration's type.
1482 //
1483 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1484 // class ever has member declarations.
1485 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1486 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1487 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1488 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1489
1490 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1491 // conversion is non-trivial.
1492 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1493 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001494 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001495 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001496 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001497 return true;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001498
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001499 QualType UType = URecordType;
1500 if (PointerConversions)
1501 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001502 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001503 /*isLvalue=*/!PointerConversions, BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001504 FromType = UType;
1505 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1506 }
1507
1508 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1509 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1510 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001511 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001512
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001513 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
1514 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1515 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001516 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001517 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001518
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001519 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001520 /*isLvalue=*/!PointerConversions, BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001521 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001522}
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001523
Douglas Gregorf405d7e2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001524/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001525static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedman2cfcef62009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001526 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001527 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
1528 SourceLocation Loc, QualType Ty,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001529 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1530 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1531 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001532 if (SS.isSet()) {
1533 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1534 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001535 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001536
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001537 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001538 Member, FoundDecl, Loc, TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001539}
1540
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001541/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1542/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1543/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1544/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001545Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001546Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1547 LookupResult &R,
1548 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1549 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001550 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1551
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001552 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001553
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001554 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1555 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregor6493d9c2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001556 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001557 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001558 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001559 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001560 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001561
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001562 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1563 // 'this' expression now.
1564 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)->getThisType(Context);
1565 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1566 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001567 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1568 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1569 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1570 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001571 }
1572
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001573 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, This), ThisType,
1574 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1575 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001576 SS,
1577 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1578 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001579}
1580
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001581bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001582 const LookupResult &R,
1583 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001584 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1585 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1586 return false;
1587
1588 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001589 if (SS.isSet())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001590 return false;
1591
1592 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001593 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001594 return false;
1595
1596 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1597 // normal lookup:
1598 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1599 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1600
1601 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1602 // -- a declaration of a class member
1603 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1604 // original decl.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001605 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001606 return false;
1607
1608 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1609 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1610 // using-declaration
1611 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1612 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1613 // turn off ADL anyway).
1614 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1615 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1616 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1617 return false;
1618
1619 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1620 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1621 // template
1622 // And also for builtin functions.
1623 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1624 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1625
1626 // But also builtin functions.
1627 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1628 return false;
1629 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1630 return false;
1631 }
1632
1633 return true;
1634}
1635
1636
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001637/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1638/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1639/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1640/// will in fact be used.
1641static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1642 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1643 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1644 return true;
1645 }
1646
1647 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1648 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1649 return true;
1650 }
1651
1652 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1653 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1654 return true;
1655 }
1656
1657 return false;
1658}
1659
1660Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001661Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001662 LookupResult &R,
1663 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCall3a60c872009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001664 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1665 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor4b4844f2010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001666 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001667 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001668
1669 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1670 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1671 // functions and function templates.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001672 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1673 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001674 return ExprError();
1675
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001676 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1677 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1678 // we've picked a target.
1679 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1680
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001681 bool Dependent
1682 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001683 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001684 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001685 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
1686 SS.getRange(),
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001687 R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
1688 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult());
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001689 ULE->addDecls(R.begin(), R.end());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001690
1691 return Owned(ULE);
1692}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001693
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001694
1695/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
1696Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001697Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001698 SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1699 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001700 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1701 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001702
1703 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1704 return ExprError();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00001705
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001706 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1707 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1708 // a template argument list.
1709 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1710 << Template << SS.getRange();
1711 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1712 return ExprError();
1713 }
1714
1715 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1716 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1717 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001718 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001719 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCallb48971d2009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001720 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001721 return ExprError();
1722 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001723
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001724 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1725 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1726 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1727 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001728 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001729 return ExprError();
1730
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001731 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1732 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001733 return ExprError();
1734
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001735 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1736 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1737 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1738 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001739 //
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001740 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1741 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1742 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001743 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001744 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump7dafa0d2010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001745 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1746 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1747 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1748 return ExprError();
1749 }
1750
Fariborz Jahanianfa24e102010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001751 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump8971a862010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001752 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1753 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1754 return ExprError();
1755 }
1756
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001757 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001758 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001759 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001760 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001761 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001762 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1763 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001764 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001765
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001766 ExprTy.addConst();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001767 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001768 constAdded));
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001769 }
1770 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1771 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001772
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001773 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(), Loc, &SS);
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001774}
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001775
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001776Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
1777 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001778 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001779
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001780 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001781 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001782 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1783 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1784 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001785 }
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001786
Chris Lattnera81a0272008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001787 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1788 // string.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001789
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001790 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
1791 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001792 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001793 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001794 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001795
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001796 QualType ResTy;
1797 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1798 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1799 } else {
Anders Carlsson5bd8d192010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001800 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001801
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001802 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001803 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001804 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1805 }
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001806 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001807}
1808
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001809Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001810 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001811 bool Invalid = false;
1812 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1813 if (Invalid)
1814 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001815
Benjamin Kramer0a1abd42010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001816 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1817 PP);
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001818 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001819 return ExprError();
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001820
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001821 QualType Ty;
1822 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1823 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1824 else if (Literal.isWide())
1825 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedmaneb1df702010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001826 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1827 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001828 else
1829 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001830
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001831 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1832 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001833 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001834}
1835
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001836Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
1837 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001838 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1839 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner9240b3e2009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001840 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattnerc4c18192009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001841 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001842 return Owned(new (Context) IntegerLiteral(llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff5faaef72009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001843 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001844 }
Ted Kremeneke9814182009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001845
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001846 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattnera1cf5f92008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001847 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1848 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Steve Naroff8160ea22007-03-06 01:09:46 +00001849 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001850
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001851 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001852 bool Invalid = false;
1853 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1854 if (Invalid)
1855 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001856
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001857 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Steve Naroff451d8f162007-03-12 23:22:38 +00001858 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001859 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001860 return ExprError();
1861
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001862 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001863
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001864 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001865 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001866 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001867 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001868 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001869 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001870 else
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001871 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001872
1873 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1874
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001875 using llvm::APFloat;
1876 APFloat Val(Format);
1877
1878 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall122c8312009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001879
1880 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1881 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1882 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1883 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001884 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001885 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001886 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001887 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001888 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
1889 } else {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001890 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001891 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
1892 }
1893
1894 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
1895 << Ty
1896 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
1897 }
1898
1899 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Chris Lattnere4edb8e2009-06-29 17:34:55 +00001900 Res = new (Context) FloatingLiteral(Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001901
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001902 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001903 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001904 } else {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001905 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001906
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001907 // long long is a C99 feature.
1908 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth4a1ee052007-08-29 22:13:52 +00001909 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001910 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
1911
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001912 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001913 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001914
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001915 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
1916 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
1917 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001918 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
1919 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001920 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001921 } else {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001922 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
1923 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001924
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001925 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
1926 // be an unsigned int.
1927 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
1928
1929 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001930 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner7b939cf2007-08-23 21:58:08 +00001931 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
1932 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001933 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001934
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001935 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
1936 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
1937 // Does it fit in a signed int?
1938 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001939 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001940 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001941 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001942 Width = IntSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001943 }
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001944 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001945
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001946 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001947 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001948 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001949
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001950 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
1951 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
1952 // Does it fit in a signed long?
1953 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001954 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001955 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001956 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001957 Width = LongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001958 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001959 }
1960
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001961 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001962 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001963 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001964
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001965 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
1966 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
1967 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
1968 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001969 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001970 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001971 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001972 Width = LongLongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001973 }
1974 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001975
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001976 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
1977 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001978 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001979 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001980 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001981 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001982 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001983
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001984 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
1985 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001986 }
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001987 Res = new (Context) IntegerLiteral(ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001988 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001989
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001990 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
1991 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001992 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001993 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001994
1995 return Owned(Res);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001996}
1997
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001998Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
1999 SourceLocation R, ExprArg Val) {
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00002000 Expr *E = Val.takeAs<Expr>();
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002001 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002002 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002003}
2004
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00002005/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00002006/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002007bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002008 SourceLocation OpLoc,
2009 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
2010 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002011 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2012 return false;
2013
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002014 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2015 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2016 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2017 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2018 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2019 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2020
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002021 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002022 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002023 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002024 if (isSizeof)
2025 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2026 return false;
2027 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002028
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002029 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002030 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002031 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2032 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002033 return false;
2034 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002035
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002036 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002037 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2038 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002039 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002040
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002041 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
Fariborz Jahanian1dcb3222009-04-24 17:34:33 +00002042 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCInterfaceType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002043 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattnercd2a8c52009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002044 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2045 return true;
Chris Lattner37920f52009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002046 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002047
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002048 return false;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002049}
2050
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002051bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2052 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2053 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002054
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002055 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002056 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2057 return false;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002058
2059 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2060 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2061 return false;
2062
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002063 if (E->getBitField()) {
2064 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2065 return true;
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002066 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002067
2068 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2069 // bit-field.
2070 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002071 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002072 return false;
2073
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002074 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2075}
2076
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002077/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002078Action::OwningExprResult
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002079Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002080 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002081 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002082 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002083 return ExprError();
2084
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002085 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002086
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002087 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2088 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2089 return ExprError();
2090
2091 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002092 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002093 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2094 R.getEnd()));
2095}
2096
2097/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2098/// operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002099Action::OwningExprResult
2100Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002101 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2102 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2103 bool isInvalid = false;
2104 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2105 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2106 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2107 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002108 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002109 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2110 isInvalid = true;
2111 } else {
2112 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2113 }
2114
2115 if (isInvalid)
2116 return ExprError();
2117
2118 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2119 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2120 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2121 R.getEnd()));
2122}
2123
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002124/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2125/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2126/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002127Action::OwningExprResult
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002128Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2129 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Chris Lattner0d8b1a12006-11-20 04:34:45 +00002130 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002131 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002132
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002133 if (isType) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002134 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
2135 (void) GetTypeFromParser(TyOrEx, &TInfo);
2136 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002137 }
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002138
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002139 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
2140 Action::OwningExprResult Result
2141 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2142
2143 if (Result.isInvalid())
2144 DeleteExpr(ArgEx);
2145
2146 return move(Result);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002147}
2148
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002149QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002150 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2151 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002152
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002153 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002154 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002155 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002156
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002157 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2158 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2159 return V->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002160
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002161 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002162 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2163 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002164 return QualType();
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002165}
2166
2167
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002168
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002169Action::OwningExprResult
2170Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2171 tok::TokenKind Kind, ExprArg Input) {
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002172 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
2173 switch (Kind) {
2174 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
2175 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostInc; break;
2176 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostDec; break;
2177 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002178
Eli Friedmancfdd40c2009-11-18 03:38:04 +00002179 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, move(Input));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002180}
2181
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002182Action::OwningExprResult
2183Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2184 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002185 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
2186 Base = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Base));
2187
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002188 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get()),
2189 *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002190
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002191 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002192 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
2193 Base.release();
2194 Idx.release();
2195 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2196 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2197 }
2198
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002199 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002200 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman254a1a22008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002201 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2202 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2203 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002204 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, move(Base),move(Idx));
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002205 }
2206
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002207 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(move(Base), LLoc, move(Idx), RLoc);
2208}
2209
2210
2211Action::OwningExprResult
2212Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2213 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2214 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get());
2215 Expr *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
2216
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002217 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002218 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2219 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2220 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002221
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002222 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002223
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002224 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002225 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002226 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002227 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002228 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2229 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002230 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2231 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2232 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2233 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002234 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002235 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2236 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002237 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002238 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattneraee0cfd2007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002239 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002240 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2241 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002242 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002243 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002244 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002245 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2246 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2247 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002248 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002249 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002250 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2251 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2252 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2253 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002254 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattner41977962007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002255 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002256 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begemanc1bf0612009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002257
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002258 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2259 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002260 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2261 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002262 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002263 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2264 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2265 // force the promotion here.
2266 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2267 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002268 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
2269 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002270 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2271
2272 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2273 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002274 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002275 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2276 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2277 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2278 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002279 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
2280 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002281 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2282
2283 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2284 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002285 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroffb3096442007-06-09 03:47:53 +00002286 } else {
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002287 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2288 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002289 }
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002290 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002291 if (!(IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() &&
2292 IndexExpr->getType()->isScalarType()) && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002293 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2294 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffb29cdd52007-07-10 18:23:31 +00002295
Daniel Dunbar4782a6e2009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002296 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinigb7608d72009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002297 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2298 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig914244e2009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002299 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2300
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002301 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002302 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2303 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002304 // incomplete types are not object types.
2305 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2306 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2307 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2308 return ExprError();
2309 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002310
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002311 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002312 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002313 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2314 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002315 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002316
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002317 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
2318 if (ResultType->isObjCInterfaceType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
2319 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2320 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2321 return ExprError();
2322 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002323
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002324 Base.release();
2325 Idx.release();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002326 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002327 ResultType, RLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002328}
2329
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002330QualType Sema::
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002331CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002332 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002333 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbarc0429402009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002334 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2335 // see FIXME there.
2336 //
2337 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2338 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002339 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002340
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002341 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002342 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002343
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002344 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002345 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2346 // to be selected.
2347 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002348
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002349 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2350 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman0359e122009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002351 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002352
2353 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2354 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002355 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002356 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2357 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002358 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002359 do
2360 compStr++;
2361 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002362 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002363 do
2364 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002365 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002366 }
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002367
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002368 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002369 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2370 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002371 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
2372 << std::string(compStr,compStr+1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002373 return QualType();
2374 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002375
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002376 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2377 // operates on.
2378 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002379 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002380
2381 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002382 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002383
2384 while (*compStr) {
2385 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2386 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2387 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2388 return QualType();
2389 }
2390 }
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002391 }
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002392
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002393 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002394 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002395 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002396 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002397 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begemanac8183a2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002398 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002399 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002400 if (HexSwizzle)
2401 CompSize--;
2402
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002403 if (CompSize == 1)
2404 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002405
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002406 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002407 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002408 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2409 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2410 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2411 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffddf5a1d2007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002412 }
2413 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002414}
2415
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002416static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002417 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002418 const Selector &Sel,
2419 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002420
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002421 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002422 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002423 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002424 return OMD;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002425
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002426 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2427 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002428 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002429 Context))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002430 return D;
2431 }
2432 return 0;
2433}
2434
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002435static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002436 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002437 const Selector &Sel,
2438 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002439 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2440 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002441 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002442 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002443 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002444 GDecl = PD;
2445 break;
2446 }
2447 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002448 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002449 GDecl = OMD;
2450 break;
2451 }
2452 }
2453 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002454 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002455 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2456 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002457 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002458 if (GDecl)
2459 return GDecl;
2460 }
2461 }
2462 return GDecl;
2463}
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002464
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002465Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002466Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseType,
2467 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002468 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2469 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2470 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2471 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2472 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
2473
2474 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2475 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2476 //
2477 // T* t;
2478 // t.f;
2479 //
2480 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2481 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2482 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2483 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002484 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002485 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2486 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002487 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002488 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002489 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002490 return ExprError();
2491 }
2492 }
2493
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002494 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002495 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002496
2497 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2498 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002499 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002500 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2501 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep()),
2502 SS.getRange(),
2503 FirstQualifierInScope,
2504 Name, NameLoc,
2505 TemplateArgs));
2506}
2507
2508/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2509/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2510/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2511static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2512 Expr *BaseExpr,
2513 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002514 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002515 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002516 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2517 // diagnostics.
2518 if (!BaseExpr)
2519 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002520
John McCall1e67dd62010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002521 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2522 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002523}
2524
2525// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2526// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2527// type. The restriction here is:
2528//
2529// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2530// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2531// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2532//
2533// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2534// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2535// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2536// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2537bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2538 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002539 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002540 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002541 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2542 if (!BaseRT) {
2543 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2544 // dependent.
2545 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2546 return false;
2547 }
2548 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002549
2550 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002551 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2552 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002553 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002554 return false;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002555
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002556 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
2557 CXXRecordDecl *RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>((*I)->getDeclContext());
2558 while (RecordD->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
2559 RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordD->getParent());
2560
2561 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
2562 MemberRecord.insert(RecordD->getCanonicalDecl());
2563
2564 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2565 return false;
2566 }
2567
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002568 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002569 return true;
2570}
2571
2572static bool
2573LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2574 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002575 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002576 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2577 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002578 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002579 << BaseRange))
2580 return true;
2581
2582 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2583 if (SS.isSet()) {
2584 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2585 // nested-name-specifier.
2586 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2587
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002588 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002589 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2590 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2591 return true;
2592 }
2593
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002594 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002595
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002596 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2597 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2598 << DC << SS.getRange();
2599 return true;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002600 }
2601 }
2602
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002603 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2604 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002605
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002606 if (!R.empty())
2607 return false;
2608
2609 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2610 // for typos.
2611 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002612 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002613 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002614 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2615 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2616 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002617 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2618 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002619 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2620 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2621 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002622 return false;
2623 } else {
2624 R.clear();
2625 }
2626
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002627 return false;
2628}
2629
2630Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002631Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg BaseArg, QualType BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002632 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002633 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002634 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2635 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2636 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2637 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
2638
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002639 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2640 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002641 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002642 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2643 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2644 Name, NameLoc,
2645 TemplateArgs);
2646
2647 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002648
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002649 // Implicit member accesses.
2650 if (!Base) {
2651 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2652 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2653 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2654 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
2655 OpLoc, SS))
2656 return ExprError();
2657
2658 // Explicit member accesses.
2659 } else {
2660 OwningExprResult Result =
2661 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002662 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ DeclPtrTy());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002663
2664 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2665 Owned(Base);
2666 return ExprError();
2667 }
2668
2669 if (Result.get())
2670 return move(Result);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002671 }
2672
Sebastian Redl0b4e3122010-05-07 09:09:23 +00002673 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002674 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2675 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002676}
2677
2678Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002679Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseExprType,
2680 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2681 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002682 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002683 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002684 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2685 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002686 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002687 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002688 if (IsArrow) {
2689 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2690 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2691 }
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002692 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002693
2694 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier =
2695 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep());
2696 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2697 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
2698
2699 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002700 return ExprError();
2701
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002702 if (R.empty()) {
2703 // Rederive where we looked up.
2704 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2705 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2706 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002707
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002708 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002709 << MemberName << DC
2710 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002711 return ExprError();
2712 }
2713
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002714 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2715 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2716 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2717 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2718 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2719 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2720 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2721 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2722 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2723 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002724 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002725 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002726 return ExprError();
2727
2728 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2729 // result.
2730 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002731 bool Dependent =
John McCall71739032009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002732 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002733 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002734 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002735
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002736 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2737 // pick a member.
2738 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2739
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002740 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2741 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2742 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002743 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2744 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002745 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
2746 MemberName, MemberLoc,
2747 TemplateArgs);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002748 MemExpr->addDecls(R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002749
2750 return Owned(MemExpr);
2751 }
2752
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002753 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002754 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002755 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2756
2757 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2758
2759 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2760 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2761 // error cases.
2762 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2763 return ExprError();
2764
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002765 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2766 if (!BaseExpr) {
2767 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002768 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002769 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), MemberDecl);
2770
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002771 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2772 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2773 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2774 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002775 }
2776
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002777 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2778 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2779 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2780 // explicitly qualified.
2781 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2782 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2783 }
2784
2785 // Check the use of this member.
2786 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2787 Owned(BaseExpr);
2788 return ExprError();
2789 }
2790
2791 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2792 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2793 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman78cde142009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002794 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2795 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002796 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2797 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2798
2799 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2800 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2801 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2802 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2803 else {
2804 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2805 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2806 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2807
2808 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2809 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2810
2811 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2812 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2813 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2814 }
2815
2816 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002817 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002818 return ExprError();
2819 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002820 FD, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, MemberType));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002821 }
2822
2823 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2824 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2825 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002826 Var, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002827 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2828 }
2829
2830 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2831 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2832 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002833 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002834 MemberFn->getType()));
2835 }
2836
2837 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2838 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2839 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002840 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, Enum->getType()));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002841 }
2842
2843 Owned(BaseExpr);
2844
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002845 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002846 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002847 Diag(MemberLoc,diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
2848 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2849 else
2850 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2851 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002852
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002853 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2854 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002855 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002856 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002857}
2858
2859/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2860/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2861/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2862/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2863/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2864/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2865/// an ordinary member expression.
2866///
2867/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2868/// fixed for ObjC++.
2869Sema::OwningExprResult
2870Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002871 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002872 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002873 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00002874 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002875
Steve Naroffeaaae462007-12-16 21:42:28 +00002876 // Perform default conversions.
2877 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002878
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002879 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002880 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
2881
2882 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2883 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002884
2885 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002886 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002887 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
2888 // call, and continue on.
2889 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2890 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
2891 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
2892 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
2893 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002894 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
2895 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002896 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
2897 ->isRecordType()))) {
2898 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
2899 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
2900 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002901 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002902
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002903 OwningExprResult NewBase
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002904 = ActOnCallExpr(0, ExprArg(*this, BaseExpr), Loc,
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002905 MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), 0, Loc);
2906 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002907 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002908
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002909 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
2910 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
2911 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
2912 }
2913 }
2914 }
2915
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002916 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2917 // use that.
2918 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002919 if (IsArrow) {
2920 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
2921 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
2922 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
2923 if (OPT->getPointeeType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ObjCId) &&
2924 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00002925 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
2926 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002927 }
2928 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002929 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2930 // is a reference to 'isa'.
2931 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
2932 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002933 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002934 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002935 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002936
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00002937 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2938 // use that.
2939 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
2940 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2941 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
2942 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
2943 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
2944 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
2945 }
2946 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002947
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002948 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002949
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002950 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002951 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002952 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
2953 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
2954 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
2955 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
2956 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
2957 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
2958 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
2959 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
2960 // Check the use of this method.
2961 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
2962 return ExprError();
2963 }
2964 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
2965 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
2966 Selector SetterSel =
2967 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
2968 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
2969 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
2970 if (!Setter) {
2971 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
2972 // methods.
Steve Naroffbb69c942009-10-01 23:46:04 +00002973 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002974 }
2975 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
2976 if (!Setter)
2977 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002978
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002979 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
2980 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002981
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002982 if (Getter || Setter) {
2983 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002984
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002985 if (Getter)
2986 PType = Getter->getResultType();
2987 else
2988 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
2989 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
2990 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002991 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002992 PType,
2993 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
2994 }
2995 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
2996 << MemberName << BaseType);
2997 }
2998 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002999
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003000 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3001 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3002 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003003 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003004 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003005
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003006 if (IsArrow) {
3007 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003008 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003009 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3010 ;
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003011 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3012 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3013 // struct MyRecord foo;
3014 // foo->bar
3015 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3016 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3017 // by now.
3018 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3019 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003020 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003021 IsArrow = false;
3022 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003023 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3024 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3025 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson524d5a42009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003026 }
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003027 } else {
3028 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3029 // type *foo;
3030 // foo.bar
3031 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3032 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3033 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3034 // the appropriate pointer type
3035 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3036 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3037 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3038 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3039 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003040 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003041 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3042 IsArrow = true;
3043 }
3044 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003045 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003046
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003047 // Handle field access to simple records. This also handles access
3048 // to fields of the ObjC 'id' struct.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003049 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003050 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
3051 RTy, OpLoc, SS))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003052 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003053 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003054 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003055
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003056 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3057 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003058 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
3059 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCInterfaceType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003060 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003061 const ObjCInterfaceType *IFaceT =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003062 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceType() : BaseType->getAs<ObjCInterfaceType>();
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003063 if (IFaceT) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003064 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3065
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003066 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = IFaceT->getDecl();
3067 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003068 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003069
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003070 if (!IV) {
3071 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3072 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3073 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003074 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003075 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003076 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003077 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3078 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003079 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3080 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003081 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003082 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003083 }
3084 }
3085
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003086 if (IV) {
3087 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3088 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3089 // error cases.
3090 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3091 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003092
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003093 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3094 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3095 return ExprError();
3096 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3097 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3098 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3099 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3100 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3101 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3102 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3103 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3104 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3105 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3106 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3107 // AST for a function decl.
3108 Decl *ImplDecl = ObjCImpDecl.getAs<Decl>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003109 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003110 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ImplDecl))
3111 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3112 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
3113 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ImplDecl))
3114 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3115 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003116
3117 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3118 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003119 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003120 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003121 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003122 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3123 // @protected
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003124 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003125 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffd1b64be2009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003126 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003127
3128 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3129 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003130 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahaniana458c4f2009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003131 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003132 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003133 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003134 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianb1378f92008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003135 }
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003136 }
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003137 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003138 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3139 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003140 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003141 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003142
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003143 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003144 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003145 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3146 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3147 // Check the use of this declaration
3148 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3149 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003150
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003151 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3152 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3153 }
3154 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3155 // Check the use of this method.
3156 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3157 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003158
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003159 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor9a129192010-04-21 00:45:42 +00003160 OMD->getResultType().getNonReferenceType(),
3161 OpLoc, BaseExpr, Sel,
3162 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberLoc));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003163 }
3164 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003165
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003166 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003167 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003168 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003169
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003170 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3171 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner2b1ca5f2010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003172 if (!IsArrow)
3173 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3174 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattner90c58fa2010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003175 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003176
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003177 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003178 if (!IsArrow &&
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003179 BaseType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ObjCId) &&
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003180 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003181 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003182 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003183
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003184 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner6c7ce102009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003185 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003186 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003187 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3188 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003189 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003190 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003191 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003192 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003193
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003194 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3195 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3196
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003197 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003198}
3199
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003200/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3201/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3202/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3203/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3204/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3205///
3206/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3207/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3208/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3209/// only be called
3210/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3211/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3212/// aren't properly put in the context chain
3213Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg BaseArg,
3214 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3215 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003216 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003217 UnqualifiedId &Id,
3218 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl,
3219 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3220 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3221 return ExprError();
3222
3223 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3224
3225 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
3226 DeclarationName Name;
3227 SourceLocation NameLoc;
3228 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3229 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
3230 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
3231
3232 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3233
3234 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3235 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3236 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3237
3238 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
3239 BaseArg = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(BaseArg));
3240
3241 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
3242 OwningExprResult Result(*this);
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003243 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3244 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003245 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003246 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3247 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3248 Name, NameLoc,
3249 TemplateArgs);
3250 } else {
3251 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
3252 if (TemplateArgs) {
3253 // Re-use the lookup done for the template name.
3254 DecomposeTemplateName(R, Id);
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003255
Douglas Gregor9262f472010-04-27 18:19:34 +00003256 // Re-derive the naming class.
3257 if (SS.isSet()) {
3258 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier
3259 = static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier *>(SS.getScopeRep());
3260 if (const Type *Ty = Qualifier->getAsType())
3261 if (CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
3262 R.setNamingClass(NamingClass);
3263 } else {
3264 QualType BaseType = Base->getType();
3265 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
3266 BaseType = Ptr->getPointeeType();
3267 if (CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = BaseType->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
3268 R.setNamingClass(NamingClass);
3269 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003270 } else {
3271 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003272 SS, ObjCImpDecl);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003273
3274 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3275 Owned(Base);
3276 return ExprError();
3277 }
3278
3279 if (Result.get()) {
3280 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3281 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3282 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3283 // call now.
3284 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3285 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
Douglas Gregor0d5b0a12010-02-24 21:29:12 +00003286 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameLoc, move(Result));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003287
3288 return move(Result);
3289 }
3290 }
3291
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003292 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003293 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3294 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003295 }
3296
3297 return move(Result);
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003298}
3299
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003300Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3301 FunctionDecl *FD,
3302 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3303 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
3304 Diag (CallLoc,
3305 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3306 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003307 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003308 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
3309 } else {
3310 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3311 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
3312
3313 // Instantiate the expression.
Douglas Gregor8c702532010-02-05 07:33:43 +00003314 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3315 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson657bad42009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003316
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003317 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param,
3318 ArgList.getInnermost().getFlatArgumentList(),
Douglas Gregor01afeef2009-08-28 20:31:08 +00003319 ArgList.getInnermost().flat_size());
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003320
John McCall76d824f2009-08-25 22:02:44 +00003321 OwningExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003322 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003323 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003324
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003325 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3326 InitializedEntity Entity
3327 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3328 InitializationKind Kind
3329 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3330 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3331 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
3332
3333 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003334 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003335 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&ResultE, 1));
3336 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003337 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003338
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003339 // Build the default argument expression.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003340 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003341 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003342 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003343
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003344 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3345 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3346 // be properly destroyed.
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003347 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3348 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Anders Carlsson714d0962009-12-15 19:16:31 +00003349 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i)
3350 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003351 }
3352
3353 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003354 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003355}
3356
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003357/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3358/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3359/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3360/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3361/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3362/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003363bool
3364Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003365 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003366 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003367 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3368 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003369 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003370 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3371 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003372 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003373
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003374 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3375 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3376 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3377 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3378 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003379 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherabf1e182010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003380 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003381 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003382 }
3383
3384 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3385 // them.
3386 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3387 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3388 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3389 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003390 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopher2a5aaff2010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003391 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003392 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3393 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3394 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003395 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003396 return true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003397 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003398 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003399 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003400 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003401 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3402 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3403 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3404 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3405 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003406 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian4fa66ce2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003407 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003408 if (Invalid)
3409 return true;
3410 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3411 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3412 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003413
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003414 return false;
3415}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003416
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003417bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3418 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3419 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3420 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3421 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3422 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003423 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003424 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3425 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3426 bool Invalid = false;
3427 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3428 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3429 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3430 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003431 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003432 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003433 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003434
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003435 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003436 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3437 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003438
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003439 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3440 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003441 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003442 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003443 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003444
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003445 // Pass the argument
3446 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3447 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3448 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregor96596c92009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003449
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003450
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003451 InitializedEntity Entity =
3452 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3453 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
3454 OwningExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3455 SourceLocation(),
3456 Owned(Arg));
3457 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3458 return true;
3459
3460 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003461 } else {
Anders Carlssonc80a1272009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003462 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003463
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003464 OwningExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003465 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003466 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3467 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003468
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003469 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003470 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003471 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003472 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003473
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003474 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003475 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003476 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003477 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i < NumArgs; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003478 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00003479 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003480 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003481 }
3482 }
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003483 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003484}
3485
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003486/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003487/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3488/// locations.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003489Action::OwningExprResult
3490Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3491 MultiExprArg args,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003492 SourceLocation *CommaLocs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003493 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003494
3495 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
3496 fn = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(fn));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003497
Anders Carlsson3cbc8592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00003498 Expr *Fn = fn.takeAs<Expr>();
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003499 Expr **Args = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(args.release());
Chris Lattner38dbdb22007-07-21 03:03:59 +00003500 assert(Fn && "no function call expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003501
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003502 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003503 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3504 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3505 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3506 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3507 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003508 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003509 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3510 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003511
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003512 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3513 Args[I]->Destroy(Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003514
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003515 NumArgs = 0;
3516 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003517
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003518 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3519 RParenLoc));
3520 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003521
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003522 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003523 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003524 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3525 // Fn.
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003526 bool Dependent = false;
3527 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3528 Dependent = true;
3529 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3530 Dependent = true;
3531
3532 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003533 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003534 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3535
3536 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3537 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3538 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3539 CommaLocs, RParenLoc));
3540
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003541 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3542
3543 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3544 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3545 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3546 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3547 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3548 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3549 // method template.
3550 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003551 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3552 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor8f184a32009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003553 (void)MemE;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003554
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003555 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3556 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003557 }
3558
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003559 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003560 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003561 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003562 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003563 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3564 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003565 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003566
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003567 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003568 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003569 if (BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemD ||
3570 BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregorc8be9522010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003571 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3572 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003573 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003574
3575 ExprOwningPtr<CXXMemberCallExpr>
3576 TheCall(this, new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003577 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3578 RParenLoc));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003579
3580 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3581 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003582 TheCall.get(), 0))
3583 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson63dce022009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003584
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003585 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003586 RParenLoc))
3587 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003588
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003589 return Owned(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.release()).release());
3590 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003591 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003592 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3593 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003594 }
3595 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003596 }
3597
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003598 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003599 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003600 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003601
Eli Friedmane14b1992009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003602 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003603 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3604 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003605 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003606 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003607 }
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003608
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003609 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3610 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3611 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3612
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003613 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3614}
3615
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003616/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3617/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003618/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3619/// block-pointer type.
3620///
3621/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
3622Sema::OwningExprResult
3623Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3624 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3625 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3626 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3627 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3628
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003629 // Promote the function operand.
3630 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3631
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003632 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3633 // of arguments and function on error.
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003634 ExprOwningPtr<CallExpr> TheCall(this, new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3635 Args, NumArgs,
3636 Context.BoolTy,
3637 RParenLoc));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003638
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003639 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3640 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3641 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3642 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003643 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003644 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003645 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3646 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003647 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003648 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003649 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003650 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003651 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003652 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003653 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3654 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3655
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003656 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003657 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003658 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall.get(),
3659 FDecl))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003660 return ExprError();
3661
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003662 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +00003663 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003664
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003665 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003666 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003667 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003668 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003669 } else {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003670 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003671
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003672 if (FDecl) {
3673 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3674 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3675 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisddcd1322009-06-30 02:35:26 +00003676 if (FDecl->getBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003677 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003678 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003679 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3680 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3681 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3682 }
3683 }
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003684 }
3685
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003686 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003687 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3688 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3689 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003690 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3691 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003692 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3693 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003694 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003695 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003696 }
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00003697 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003698
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003699 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3700 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003701 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3702 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003703
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003704 // Check for sentinels
3705 if (NDecl)
3706 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003707
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003708 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003709 if (FDecl) {
3710 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall.get()))
3711 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003712
Douglas Gregor15fc9562009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003713 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003714 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall.take());
3715 } else if (NDecl) {
3716 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall.get()))
3717 return ExprError();
3718 }
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003719
Anders Carlssonf8984012009-08-16 03:06:32 +00003720 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.take());
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003721}
3722
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003723Action::OwningExprResult
3724Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
3725 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003726 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroff57eb2c52007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003727 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003728 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003729
3730 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3731 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3732 if (!TInfo)
3733 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3734
3735 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(InitExpr));
3736}
3737
3738Action::OwningExprResult
3739Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
3740 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
3741 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003742 Expr *literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(InitExpr.get());
Anders Carlsson2c1ec6d2007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003743
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003744 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003745 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003746 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3747 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor1c37d9e2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003748 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3749 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003750 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003751 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003752 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003753 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003754
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003755 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregor1b303932009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003756 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003757 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003758 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003759 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003760 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
3761 OwningExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3762 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&literalExpr, 1),
3763 &literalType);
3764 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003765 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003766 InitExpr.release();
3767 literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Result.get());
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003768
Chris Lattner79413952008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003769 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003770 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003771 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003772 return ExprError();
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003773 }
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003774
3775 Result.release();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003776
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003777 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003778 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003779}
3780
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003781Action::OwningExprResult
3782Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003783 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3784 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
3785 Expr **InitList = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(initlist.release());
Anders Carlsson4692db02007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003786
Steve Naroff30d242c2007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003787 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003788 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003789
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003790 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3791 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003792 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003793 return Owned(E);
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003794}
3795
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003796static CastExpr::CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
3797 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003798 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003799 return CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
3800
3801 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3802 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003803 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
3804 CastExpr::CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
Fariborz Jahanian2b9fc832009-12-15 21:34:52 +00003805 CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003806 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3807 return CastExpr::CK_PointerToIntegral;
3808 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003809
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003810 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3811 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3812 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast;
3813 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
3814 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer;
3815 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3816 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToFloating;
3817 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003818
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003819 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3820 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3821 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast;
3822 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3823 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingToIntegral;
3824 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003825
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003826 // FIXME: Assert here.
3827 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
3828 return CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
3829}
3830
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003831/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redl955a0672009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003832bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003833 CastExpr::CastKind& Kind,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003834 CXXBaseSpecifierArray &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahanian1cec0c42009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003835 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003836 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003837 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3838 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003839
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003840 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003841
3842 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3843 // type needs to be scalar.
3844 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3845 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003846 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToVoid;
3847 return false;
3848 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003849
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003850 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003851 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003852 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3853 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003854 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003855 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3856 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003857 Kind = CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003858 return false;
3859 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003860
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003861 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003862 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003863 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003864 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003865 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003866 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003867 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003868 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003869 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3870 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3871 break;
3872 }
3873 }
3874 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3875 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3876 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003877 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003878 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003879 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003880
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003881 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3882 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3883 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3884 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003885
3886 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003887 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003888 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3889 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003890 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003891 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003892
3893 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003894 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003895
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003896 if (castType->isVectorType())
3897 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
3898 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
3899 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
3900
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003901 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
3902 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003903
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003904 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003905 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
3906 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType() && castExprType->isArithmeticType())
3907 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3908 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
3909 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3910 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
3911 if (!castType->isIntegralType() && castType->isArithmeticType())
3912 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3913 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
3914 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003915 }
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003916
3917 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003918 return false;
3919}
3920
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003921bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
3922 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003923 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003924
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003925 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00003926 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003927 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003928 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003929 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003930 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003931 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003932 } else
3933 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003934 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003935 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003936
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003937 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003938 return false;
3939}
3940
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003941bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003942 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003943 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003944
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003945 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003946
Nate Begemanc8961a42009-06-27 22:05:55 +00003947 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
3948 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003949 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
3950 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
3951 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
3952 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003953 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003954 return false;
3955 }
3956
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00003957 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003958 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
3959 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00003960 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
3961 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
3962 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
3963 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003964
3965 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
3966 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
3967 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003968
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003969 Kind = CastExpr::CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003970 return false;
3971}
3972
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003973Action::OwningExprResult
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003974Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003975 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
3976 assert((Ty != 0) && (Op.get() != 0) &&
3977 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff1a2cf6b2007-07-16 23:25:18 +00003978
John McCall97513962010-01-15 18:39:57 +00003979 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
3980 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
3981 if (!castTInfo)
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003982 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003983
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003984 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003985 Expr *castExpr = (Expr *)Op.get();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003986 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003987 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, move(Op),
3988 castTInfo);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003989
3990 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
3991}
3992
3993Action::OwningExprResult
3994Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
3995 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
3996 Expr *castExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Op.get());
3997
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003998 CastExpr::CastKind Kind = CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson5d270e82010-04-24 18:38:56 +00003999 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004000 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004001 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004002 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004003
Douglas Gregorb33eed02010-04-16 22:09:46 +00004004 Op.release();
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004005 return Owned(new (Context) CStyleCastExpr(Ty->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
Anders Carlsson5d270e82010-04-24 18:38:56 +00004006 Kind, castExpr, BasePath, Ty,
Anders Carlssonf10e4142009-08-07 22:21:05 +00004007 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004008}
4009
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004010/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4011/// of comma binary operators.
4012Action::OwningExprResult
4013Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg EA) {
4014 Expr *expr = EA.takeAs<Expr>();
4015 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4016 if (!E)
4017 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004018
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004019 OwningExprResult Result(*this, E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004020
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004021 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
4022 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, move(Result),
4023 Owned(E->getExpr(i)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004024
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004025 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), move(Result));
4026}
4027
4028Action::OwningExprResult
4029Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4030 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004031 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004032 ParenListExpr *PE = (ParenListExpr *)Op.get();
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004033 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004034
4035 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004036 // then handle it as such.
4037 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4038 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4039 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4040 return ExprError();
4041 }
4042
4043 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4044 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4045 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4046
4047 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4048 // braces instead of the original commas.
4049 Op.release();
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004050 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4051 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004052 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4053 E->setType(Ty);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004054 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Owned(E));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004055 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004056 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004057 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
4058 Op = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Op));
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004059 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004060 }
4061}
4062
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004063Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004064 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004065 MultiExprArg Val,
4066 TypeTy *TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004067 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4068 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004069 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4070 Expr *expr;
4071 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4072 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4073 else
4074 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004075 return Owned(expr);
4076}
4077
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004078/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4079/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004080/// C99 6.5.15
4081QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4082 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004083 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4084 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
4085 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
4086
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004087 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
4088 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
4089 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4090 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4091 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4092 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004093
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004094 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004095 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
4096 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4097 << CondTy;
4098 return QualType();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004099 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004100
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004101 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004102 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4103 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004104
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004105 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4106 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004107 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4108 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4109 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004110 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004111
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004112 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4113 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004114 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4115 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004116 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004117 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004118 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004119 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004120 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004121 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004122
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004123 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004124 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004125 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4126 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4127 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4128 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4129 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4130 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4131 << LHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004132 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
4133 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman3e1852f2008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004134 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004135 }
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004136 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4137 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004138 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004139 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004140 // promote the null to a pointer.
4141 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004142 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004143 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004144 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004145 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004146 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004147 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004148 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004149
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004150 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4151 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4152 QuestionLoc);
4153 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4154 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004155
4156
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004157 // Handle block pointer types.
4158 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4159 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4160 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4161 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004162 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4163 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004164 return destType;
4165 }
4166 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004167 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004168 return QualType();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004169 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004170 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4171 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4172 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004173 return LHSTy;
4174 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004175 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004176 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4177 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004178
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004179 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4180 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004181 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004182 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004183 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4184 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4185 // to get a consistent AST.
4186 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004187 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4188 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004189 return incompatTy;
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004190 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004191 // The block pointer types are compatible.
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004192 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4193 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroffea4c7802009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004194 return LHSTy;
4195 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004196
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004197 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4198 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4199 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004200 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4201 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004202
4203 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4204 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4205 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004206 QualType destPointee
4207 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004208 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004209 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4210 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4211 // Promote to void*.
4212 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004213 return destType;
4214 }
4215 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004216 QualType destPointee
4217 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004218 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004219 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004220 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004221 // Promote to void*.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004222 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004223 return destType;
4224 }
4225
4226 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4227 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4228 return LHSTy;
4229 }
4230 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4231 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4232 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4233 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4234 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4235 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4236 // to get a consistent AST.
4237 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004238 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4239 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004240 return incompatTy;
4241 }
4242 // The pointer types are compatible.
4243 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4244 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4245 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4246 // type.
4247 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4248 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004249 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4250 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004251 return LHSTy;
4252 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004253
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004254 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4255 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4256 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4257 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004258 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004259 return RHSTy;
4260 }
4261 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4262 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4263 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004264 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004265 return LHSTy;
4266 }
Daniel Dunbar484603b2008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004267
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004268 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004269 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4270 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004271 return QualType();
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004272}
4273
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004274/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4275/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4276QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4277 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4278 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4279 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004280
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004281 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4282 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4283 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4284 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4285 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4286 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4287 return LHSTy;
4288 }
4289 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4290 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4291 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4292 return RHSTy;
4293 }
4294 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4295 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4296 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4297 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4298 return LHSTy;
4299 }
4300 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4301 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4302 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4303 return RHSTy;
4304 }
4305 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4306 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4307 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4308 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4309 return LHSTy;
4310 }
4311 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4312 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4313 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4314 return RHSTy;
4315 }
4316 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4317 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004318
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004319 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4320 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4321 return LHSTy;
4322 }
4323 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4324 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4325 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004326
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004327 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4328 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4329 // type. This allows
4330 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4331 // where B is a subclass of A.
4332 //
4333 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4334 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4335 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4336 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004337
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004338 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4339 // It could return the composite type.
4340 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4341 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4342 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4343 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4344 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4345 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4346 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4347 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4348 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4349 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4350 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4351 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4352 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4353 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004354 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004355 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4356 ;
4357 else {
4358 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4359 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4360 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4361 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
4362 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4363 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4364 return incompatTy;
4365 }
4366 // The object pointer types are compatible.
4367 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4368 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4369 return compositeType;
4370 }
4371 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4372 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4373 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4374 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4375 QualType destPointee
4376 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4377 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4378 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4379 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4380 // Promote to void*.
4381 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4382 return destType;
4383 }
4384 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4385 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4386 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4387 QualType destPointee
4388 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4389 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4390 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4391 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4392 // Promote to void*.
4393 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4394 return destType;
4395 }
4396 return QualType();
4397}
4398
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004399/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004400/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004401Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
4402 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
4403 ExprArg Cond, ExprArg LHS,
4404 ExprArg RHS) {
4405 Expr *CondExpr = (Expr *) Cond.get();
4406 Expr *LHSExpr = (Expr *) LHS.get(), *RHSExpr = (Expr *) RHS.get();
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004407
4408 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4409 // was the condition.
4410 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
4411 if (isLHSNull)
4412 LHSExpr = CondExpr;
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004413
4414 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr,
Chris Lattnerdaaa9f22007-07-16 21:39:03 +00004415 RHSExpr, QuestionLoc);
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004416 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004417 return ExprError();
4418
4419 Cond.release();
4420 LHS.release();
4421 RHS.release();
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004422 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004423 isLHSNull ? 0 : LHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004424 ColonLoc, RHSExpr, result));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004425}
4426
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004427// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004428// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004429// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4430// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4431// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004432Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004433Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004434 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004435
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004436 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4437 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4438 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4439 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4440 return Compatible;
4441 }
4442
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004443 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004444 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4445 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004446
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004447 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004448 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4449 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004450
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004451 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004452
4453 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4454 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4455 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianece85822009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004456 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004457 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004458 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004459
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004460 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4461 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004462 // version of void...
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004463 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004464 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004465 return ConvTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004466
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004467 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004468 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4469 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004470 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004471
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004472 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004473 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004474 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004475
4476 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004477 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4478 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004479 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004480 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004481 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004482 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4483 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4484 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4485 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4486 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4487 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004488 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004489 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004490 else if (lhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004491 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004492
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004493 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004494 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004495 else if (rhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004496 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004497
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004498 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4499 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4500 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4501 // warning can be disabled.
4502 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4503 return ConvTy;
4504 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4505 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004506
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004507 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4508 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4509 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4510 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4511 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4512 do {
4513 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4514 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004515
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004516 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4517 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4518 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004519
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004520 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004521 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004522 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004523
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004524 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004525 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004526 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004527 return ConvTy;
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004528}
4529
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004530/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4531/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4532/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4533// types.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004534Sema::AssignConvertType
4535Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004536 QualType rhsType) {
4537 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004538
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004539 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004540 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4541 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004542
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004543 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4544 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4545 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004546
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004547 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004548
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004549 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004550 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004551 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004552
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004553 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4554 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4555 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4556 }
4557 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004558 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004559 return ConvTy;
4560}
4561
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004562/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4563/// for assignment compatibility.
4564Sema::AssignConvertType
4565Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004566 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4567 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004568 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4569 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004570 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004571 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004572 }
4573 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4574 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004575 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4576 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004577 return IncompatiblePointer;
4578 return Compatible;
4579 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004580 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004581 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004582 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004583 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4584 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4585 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4586 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4587 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4588 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004589
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004590 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4591 return Compatible;
4592 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4593 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004594 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004595}
4596
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004597/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4598/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004599/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4600///
4601/// int a, *pint;
4602/// short *pshort;
4603/// struct foo *pfoo;
4604///
4605/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4606/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4607/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4608/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4609///
4610/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004611/// C99 spec dictates.
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004612///
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004613Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004614Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004615 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4616 // them.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004617 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4618 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004619
4620 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerf5c973d2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004621 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff44fd8ff2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004622
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004623 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4624 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4625 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4626 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4627 return Compatible;
4628 }
4629
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004630 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4631 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4632 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4633 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4634 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4635 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4636 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004637 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004638 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson24ebce62007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004639 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004640 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahaniana1e34202007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004641 }
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004642 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4643 // to the same ExtVector type.
4644 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4645 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4646 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
4647 if (!rhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType())
4648 return Compatible;
4649 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004650
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004651 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004652 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004653 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004654 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004655 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4656 lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004657 if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType))
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004658 return IncompatibleVectors;
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004659 }
4660 return Incompatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004661 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004662
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004663 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004664 return Compatible;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004665
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004666 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004667 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004668 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004669
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004670 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004671 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004672
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004673 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004674 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004675 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4676 return Compatible;
4677 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004678 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004679 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4680 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004681 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004682
4683 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004684 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004685 return Compatible;
4686 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004687 return Incompatible;
4688 }
4689
4690 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4691 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedman8163b7a2009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004692 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004693
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004694 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004695 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004696 return Compatible;
4697
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004698 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4699 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004700
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004701 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004702 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004703 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004704 }
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004705 return Incompatible;
4706 }
4707
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004708 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4709 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4710 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004711
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004712 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004713 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004714 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4715 return Compatible;
4716 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004717 }
4718 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004719 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004720 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004721 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004722 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4723 return Compatible;
4724 }
4725 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4726 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4727 return Compatible;
4728 return Incompatible;
4729 }
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004730 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004731 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004732 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4733 return Compatible;
4734
4735 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004736 return PointerToInt;
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004737
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004738 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004739 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004740
4741 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004742 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004743 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004744 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004745 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004746 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4747 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4748 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4749 return Compatible;
4750
4751 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4752 return PointerToInt;
4753
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004754 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004755 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004756 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4757 return Compatible;
4758 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004759 }
4760 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004761 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004762 return Compatible;
4763 return Incompatible;
4764 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004765
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004766 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004767 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004768 return Compatible;
Bill Wendling216423b2007-05-30 06:30:29 +00004769 }
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004770 return Incompatible;
Steve Naroff9eb24652007-05-02 21:58:15 +00004771}
4772
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004773/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4774/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004775static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004776 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4777 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4778 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004779 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenek013041e2010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004780 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004781 SourceLocation());
4782 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4783 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4784
4785 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4786 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004787 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004788 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004789 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004790}
4791
4792Sema::AssignConvertType
4793Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4794 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4795
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004796 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004797 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4798 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004799 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004800 return Incompatible;
4801
4802 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4803 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4804 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4805 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004806 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4807 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004808 it != itend; ++it) {
4809 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4810 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4811 // 1) void pointer
4812 // 2) null pointer constant
4813 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004814 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004815 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004816 InitField = *it;
4817 break;
4818 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004819
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004820 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004821 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004822 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004823 InitField = *it;
4824 break;
4825 }
4826 }
4827
4828 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4829 == Compatible) {
4830 InitField = *it;
4831 break;
4832 }
4833 }
4834
4835 if (!InitField)
4836 return Incompatible;
4837
4838 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
4839 return Compatible;
4840}
4841
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004842Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004843Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004844 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4845 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
4846 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
4847 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
4848 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00004849 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00004850 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004851 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner0d5640c2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00004852 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004853 }
4854
4855 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
4856 // structures.
4857 }
4858
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004859 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
4860 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004861 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
4862 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004863 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004864 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004865 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004866 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004867 return Compatible;
4868 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004869
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004870 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004871 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +00004872 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004873 // expressions that surpress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004874 //
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004875 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004876 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004877 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004878
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004879 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
4880 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004881
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004882 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
4883 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004884 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
4885 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
4886 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
4887 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004888 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004889 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonReferenceType(),
4890 CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004891 return result;
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004892}
4893
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004894QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004895 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00004896 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004897 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00004898 return QualType();
Steve Naroff6f49f5d2007-05-29 14:23:36 +00004899}
4900
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004901QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004902 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004903 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004904 QualType lhsType =
4905 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
4906 QualType rhsType =
4907 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004908
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004909 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004910 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00004911 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004912
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004913 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
4914 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004915 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
4916 // FIXME: Should we warn here?
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004917 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
4918 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004919 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004920 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004921 return lhsType->isExtVectorType() ? lhsType : rhsType;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004922 }
4923 }
4924 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004925
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004926 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
4927 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
4928 bool swapped = false;
4929 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4930 swapped = true;
4931 std::swap(rex, lex);
4932 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
4933 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004934
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00004935 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004936 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004937 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
4938 if (EltTy->isIntegralType() && rhsType->isIntegralType()) {
4939 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004940 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004941 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
4942 return lhsType;
4943 }
4944 }
4945 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
4946 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
4947 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004948 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004949 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
4950 return lhsType;
4951 }
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004952 }
4953 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004954
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00004955 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004956 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004957 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004958 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00004959 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00004960}
4961
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004962QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
4963 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar060d5e22009-01-05 22:42:10 +00004964 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004965 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004966
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00004967 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004968
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004969 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
4970 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
4971 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004972
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004973 // Check for division by zero.
4974 if (isDiv &&
4975 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004976 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00004977 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004978
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004979 return compType;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00004980}
4981
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004982QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004983 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00004984 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
4985 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
4986 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
4987 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
4988 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004989
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00004990 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004991
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004992 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
4993 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004994
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004995 // Check for remainder by zero.
4996 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00004997 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
4998 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004999
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005000 return compType;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005001}
5002
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005003QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005004 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005005 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5006 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5007 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5008 return compType;
5009 }
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005010
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005011 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005012
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005013 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005014 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5015 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5016 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005017 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005018 }
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005019
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005020 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5021 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005022 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005023 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5024
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005025 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005026
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005027 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005028 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005029
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005030 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5031 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005032 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5033 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005034 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005035 return QualType();
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005036 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005037
5038 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5039 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5040 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005041 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005042 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5043 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5044 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5045 return QualType();
5046 }
5047
5048 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5049 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5050 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005051 } else {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005052 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005053 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005054 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005055 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5056 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005057 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5058 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005059 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005060 return QualType();
5061 }
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005062 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
5063 if (PointeeTy->isObjCInterfaceType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
5064 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5065 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5066 return QualType();
5067 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005068
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005069 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005070 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5071 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5072 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5073 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5074 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005075 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005076 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5077 }
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005078 return PExp->getType();
5079 }
5080 }
5081
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005082 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005083}
5084
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005085// C99 6.5.6
5086QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005087 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5088 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5089 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5090 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5091 return compType;
5092 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005093
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005094 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005095
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005096 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005097
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005098 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005099 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5100 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005101 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005102 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005103 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005104
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005105 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005106 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff4eed7a12009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005107 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005108
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005109 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005110
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005111 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5112 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5113 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5114 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5115 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5116 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5117 return QualType();
5118 }
5119
5120 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5121 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5122 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5123 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5124 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005125 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005126 return QualType();
5127 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005128
5129 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5130 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5131 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005132 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005133 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005134 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005135 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005136 return QualType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005137
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005138 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
5139 if (lpointee->isObjCInterfaceType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
5140 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5141 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5142 return QualType();
5143 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005144
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005145 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005146 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5147 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5148 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5149 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5150 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5151 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005152 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005153 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5154
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005155 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005156 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005157 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005158
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005159 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005160 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman1974e532008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005161 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005162
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005163 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5164 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5165 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5166 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5167 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5168 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5169 return QualType();
5170 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005171
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005172 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5173 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5174 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5175 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005176 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005177 return QualType();
5178 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005179
5180 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5181 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5182 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5183 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5184 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005185 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5186 << rex->getSourceRange()
5187 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005188 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005189
Eli Friedman168fe152009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005190 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5191 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5192 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5193 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5194 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5195 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5196 return QualType();
5197 }
5198 } else {
5199 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5200 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5201 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5202 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5203 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5204 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5205 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5206 return QualType();
5207 }
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005208 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005209
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005210 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5211 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5212 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5213 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5214 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005215 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005216 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005217
5218 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005219 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5220 }
5221 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005222
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005223 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005224}
5225
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005226// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005227QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005228 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005229 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
5230 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005231 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005232
Nate Begemane46ee9a2009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005233 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5234 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5235 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5236
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005237 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5238 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005239 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5240 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5241 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5242 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5243 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005244 }
Chris Lattner3c133402007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005245 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005246 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005247
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005248 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005249
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005250 // Sanity-check shift operands
5251 llvm::APSInt Right;
5252 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar687fa862009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005253 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5254 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn2f085712009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005255 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005256 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5257 else {
5258 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5259 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5260 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5261 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5262 }
5263 }
5264
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005265 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005266 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005267}
5268
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005269// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005270QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005271 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
5272 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)OpaqueOpc;
5273
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005274 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005275 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005276 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005277
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005278 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
Steve Naroff47fea352007-08-10 18:26:40 +00005279 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5280 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5281 else {
5282 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5283 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5284 }
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005285 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5286 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005287
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005288 if (!lType->isFloatingType()
5289 && !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational)) {
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005290 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5291 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5292 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005293 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparisons of enum constants. These can arise
Ted Kremenekde9e9682009-03-20 19:57:37 +00005294 // from macro expansions, and are usually quite deliberate.
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005295 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5296 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
5297 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped))
5298 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped))
Ted Kremenek9ffbe412009-03-20 18:35:45 +00005299 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
5300 !isa<EnumConstantDecl>(DRL->getDecl()))
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005301 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_selfcomparison));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005302
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005303 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5304 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5305 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5306 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005307
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005308 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5309 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005310 Expr *literalString = 0;
5311 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005312 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005313 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005314 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005315 literalString = lex;
5316 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005317 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5318 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005319 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005320 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005321 literalString = rex;
5322 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5323 }
5324
5325 if (literalString) {
5326 std::string resultComparison;
5327 switch (Opc) {
5328 case BinaryOperator::LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5329 case BinaryOperator::GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5330 case BinaryOperator::LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5331 case BinaryOperator::GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5332 case BinaryOperator::EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5333 case BinaryOperator::NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
5334 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5335 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005336
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005337 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5338 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5339 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek800b66b2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005340 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005341 }
Ted Kremeneke451eae2007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005342 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005343
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005344 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005345 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005346
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005347 if (isRelational) {
5348 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005349 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005350 } else {
Ted Kremeneke2763b02007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005351 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005352 if (lType->isFloatingType() && rType->isFloatingType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005353 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005354
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005355 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005356 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005357 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005358
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005359 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005360 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005361 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005362 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005363
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005364 // All of the following pointer related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5365 // when handling null pointer constants. One day, we can consider making them
5366 // errors (when -pedantic-errors is enabled).
Steve Naroff808eb8f2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005367 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005368 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005369 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005370 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005371 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005372
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005373 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005374 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5375 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005376 if (!isRelational &&
5377 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5378 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5379 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
5380 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5381 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5382 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5383 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5384 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5385 return ResultTy;
5386 }
5387 }
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005388 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5389 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5390 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5391 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5392 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5393 //
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005394 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005395 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005396 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005397 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005398 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005399 if (T.isNull()) {
5400 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5401 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5402 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005403 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005404 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005405 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005406 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005407 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005408 }
5409
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005410 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5411 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005412 return ResultTy;
5413 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005414 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5415 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5416 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5417 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5418 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5419 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5420 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5421 }
5422 } else if (!isRelational &&
5423 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5424 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5425 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5426 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5427 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5428 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5429 }
5430 } else {
5431 // Invalid
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005432 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005433 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff75c17232007-06-13 21:41:08 +00005434 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005435 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005436 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005437 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005438 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005439
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005440 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005441 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005442 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005443 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005444 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5445 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson83133d92009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005446 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005447 return ResultTy;
5448 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005449 if (LHSIsNull &&
5450 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5451 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson83133d92009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005452 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005453 return ResultTy;
5454 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005455
5456 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005457 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005458 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5459 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005460 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5461 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5462 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5463 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5464 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5465 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5466 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5467 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005468 // types.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005469 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005470 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005471 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005472 if (T.isNull()) {
5473 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005474 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005475 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005476 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005477 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005478 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005479 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005480 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005481 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005482
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005483 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5484 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005485 return ResultTy;
5486 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005487
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005488 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005489 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5490 return ResultTy;
5491 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005492
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005493 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005494 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005495 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5496 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005497
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005498 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedmana6638ca2009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005499 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005500 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005501 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005502 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005503 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005504 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005505 }
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005506 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005507 if (!isRelational
5508 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5509 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005510 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005511 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005512 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005513 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005514 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5515 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5516 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005517 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005518 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005519 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005520 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005521
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005522 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005523 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005524 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5525 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005526 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005527 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005528 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005529 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005530
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005531 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5532 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005533 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005534 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005535 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005536 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005537 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffea54d9e2008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005538 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005539 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005540 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005541 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5542 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005543 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005544 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffb788d9b2008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005545 }
Fariborz Jahanian134cbef2007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005546 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005547 if (lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005548 unsigned DiagID = 0;
5549 if (RHSIsNull) {
5550 if (isRelational)
5551 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
5552 } else if (isRelational)
5553 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5554 else
5555 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005556
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005557 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005558 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005559 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005560 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005561 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005562 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005563 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005564 if (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005565 unsigned DiagID = 0;
5566 if (LHSIsNull) {
5567 if (isRelational)
5568 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
5569 } else if (isRelational)
5570 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5571 else
5572 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005573
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005574 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005575 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005576 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005577 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005578 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005579 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00005580 }
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005581 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005582 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5583 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005584 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005585 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005586 }
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005587 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5588 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005589 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005590 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005591 }
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005592 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005593}
5594
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005595/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005596/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005597/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5598/// types.
5599QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005600 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005601 bool isRelational) {
5602 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5603 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005604 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005605 if (vType.isNull())
5606 return vType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005607
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005608 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5609 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005610
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005611 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5612 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5613 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
5614 if (!lType->isFloatingType()) {
5615 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5616 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5617 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005618 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_selfcomparison));
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005619 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005620
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005621 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
5622 if (!isRelational && lType->isFloatingType()) {
5623 assert (rType->isFloatingType());
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005624 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005625 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005626
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005627 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5628 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5629 // elements for floating point vectors.
5630 if (lType->isIntegerType())
5631 return lType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005632
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005633 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005634 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005635 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005636 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattner5d688962009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005637 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005638 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5639
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005640 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005641 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005642 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5643}
5644
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005645inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005646 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Steve Naroff94a5aca2007-07-16 22:23:01 +00005647 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005648 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005649
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005650 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005651
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005652 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005653 return compType;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005654 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005655}
5656
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005657inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005658 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc) {
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005659 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5660 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5661 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005662
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005663 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5664 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005665
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005666 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005667 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005668
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005669 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5670 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
5671 // The operands are both implicitly converted to type bool (clause 4).
5672 StandardConversionSequence LHS;
5673 if (!IsStandardConversion(lex, Context.BoolTy,
5674 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, LHS))
5675 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005676
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005677 if (PerformImplicitConversion(lex, Context.BoolTy, LHS,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005678 AA_Passing, /*IgnoreBaseAccess=*/false))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005679 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005680
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005681 StandardConversionSequence RHS;
5682 if (!IsStandardConversion(rex, Context.BoolTy,
5683 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, RHS))
5684 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005685
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005686 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rex, Context.BoolTy, RHS,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005687 AA_Passing, /*IgnoreBaseAccess=*/false))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005688 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005689
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005690 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5691 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5692 // The result is a bool.
5693 return Context.BoolTy;
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005694}
5695
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005696/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5697/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5698/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5699///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005700static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005701 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5702 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5703 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5704 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005705 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005706 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5707 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5708 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5709 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005710 }
5711 }
5712 return false;
5713}
5714
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005715/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5716/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5717static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005718 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005719 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005720 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005721 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5722 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005723 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5724 return false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005725
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005726 unsigned Diag = 0;
5727 bool NeedType = false;
5728 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005729 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005730 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005731 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5732 NeedType = true;
5733 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005734 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005735 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5736 NeedType = true;
5737 break;
Chris Lattner9b3bbe92008-11-17 19:51:54 +00005738 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005739 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
5740 break;
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005741 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
5742 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005743 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005744 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
5745 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005746 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5747 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005748 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
5749 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregored0cfbd2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00005750 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005751 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00005752 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005753 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005754 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
5755 break;
Steve Naroffba756cb2008-09-26 14:41:28 +00005756 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005757 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5758 break;
Fariborz Jahanian8a1810f2008-11-22 18:39:36 +00005759 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
5760 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
5761 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5118c412008-11-22 20:25:50 +00005762 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
5763 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
5764 break;
Fariborz Jahaniane8d28902009-12-15 23:59:41 +00005765 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
5766 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
5767 break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005768 }
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00005769
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005770 SourceRange Assign;
5771 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
5772 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005773 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005774 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005775 else
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005776 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005777 return true;
5778}
5779
5780
5781
5782// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005783QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
5784 SourceLocation Loc,
5785 QualType CompoundType) {
5786 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
5787 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005788 return QualType();
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005789
5790 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
5791 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005792
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005793 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005794 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005795 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005796 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005797 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
5798 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
5799 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005800 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005801 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005802 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005803 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005804
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005805 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
5806 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
5807 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005808 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005809 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
5810 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
5811 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
5812 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ||
5813 UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Minus) &&
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005814 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005815 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005816 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
5817 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
5818 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattnered9f14c2009-03-09 07:11:10 +00005819 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
5820 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00005821 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
5822 << (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ? "+" : "-")
5823 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005824 }
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005825 }
5826 } else {
5827 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedmanb05c41e2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00005828 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005829 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005830
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005831 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005832 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005833 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005834
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005835 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
5836 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005837 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005838 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
5839 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00005840 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005841 // operand.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005842 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005843}
5844
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005845// C99 6.5.17
5846QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattnerf6e1e302008-07-25 20:54:07 +00005847 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005848 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
5849 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
5850 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00005851
5852 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
5853 // incomplete in C++).
5854
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005855 return RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff95af0132007-03-30 23:47:58 +00005856}
5857
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005858/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
5859/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005860QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00005861 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00005862 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
5863 return Context.DependentTy;
5864
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005865 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
5866 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Steve Naroffd50c88e2007-04-05 21:15:20 +00005867
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005868 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
5869 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
5870 if (!isInc) {
5871 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5872 return QualType();
5873 }
5874 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
5875 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5876 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005877 // OK!
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005878 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
5879 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005880
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005881 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005882 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005883 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5884 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5885 << Op->getSourceRange();
5886 return QualType();
5887 }
5888
5889 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005890 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005891 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005892 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5893 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5894 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
5895 return QualType();
5896 }
5897
5898 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005899 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005900 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005901 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005902 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005903 << ResType))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005904 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00005905 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
5906 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCInterfaceType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
5907 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5908 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
5909 return QualType();
5910 }
Eli Friedman090addd2010-01-03 00:20:48 +00005911 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005912 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
5913 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005914 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005915 } else {
5916 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00005917 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005918 return QualType();
Steve Naroff46ba1eb2007-04-03 23:13:13 +00005919 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005920 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroff9e1e5512007-08-23 21:37:33 +00005921 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005922 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00005923 return QualType();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00005924 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
5925 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
5926 // operand.
5927 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
5928 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005929}
5930
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005931/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005932/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005933/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
5934/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
5935/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
5936/// - &(x) => x
5937/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
5938/// - &s.xx => s
5939/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
5940/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
5941/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
5942/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005943static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005944 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005945 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005946 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005947 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005948 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
5949 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
5950 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005951 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00005952 return 0;
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005953 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005954 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005955 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00005956 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
5957 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005958 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
5959 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
5960 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
5961 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
5962 }
5963 return 0;
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005964 }
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005965 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
5966 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005967
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005968 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005969 case UnaryOperator::Real:
5970 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
5971 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
5972 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
5973 default:
5974 return 0;
5975 }
5976 }
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005977 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005978 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00005979 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005980 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
5981 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005982 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005983 default:
5984 return 0;
5985 }
5986}
5987
5988/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005989/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005990/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005991/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00005992/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005993/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00005994/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00005995QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005996 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
5997 op = op->IgnoreParens();
5998
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00005999 if (op->isTypeDependent())
6000 return Context.DependentTy;
6001
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006002 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6003 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6004 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
6005 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref)
6006 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6007 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6008 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6009 }
6010 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6011 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6012 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006013 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner67315442008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006014 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes17f345f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006015
Sebastian Redl9a8dd0d2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006016 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(op);
6017 if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction && ME &&
6018 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) {
6019 ValueDecl *dcl = cast<MemberExpr>(op)->getMemberDecl();
6020 // &f where f is a member of the current object, or &o.f, or &p->f
6021 // All these are not allowed, and we need to catch them before the dcl
6022 // branch of the if, below.
6023 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6024 << dcl;
6025 // FIXME: Improve this diagnostic and provide a fixit.
6026
6027 // Now recover by acting as if the function had been accessed qualified.
6028 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6029 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(dcl->getDeclContext()))
6030 .getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006031 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
6032 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6033 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6034 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6035 if (isSFINAEContext())
6036 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl9a8dd0d2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006037 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006038 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006039 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006040 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006041 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006042 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6043 << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006044 return QualType();
6045 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006046 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006047 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6048 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6049 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006050 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson8abde4b2010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006051 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006052 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006053 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemana6b47a42009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006054 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006055 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian385db802009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006056 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6057 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6058 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6059 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6060 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson3fa58d12009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006061 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6062 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson01ccf992009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006063 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6064 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006065 } else if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(op)) {
6066 return Context.OverloadTy;
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006067 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006068 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006069 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6070 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006071 if (vd->getStorageClass() == VarDecl::Register) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006072 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6073 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006074 return QualType();
6075 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006076 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006077 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006078 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor9aa8b552008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006079 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006080 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6081 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006082 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006083 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006084 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6085 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006086 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006087 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6088 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6089 return QualType();
6090 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006091
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006092 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6093 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006094 }
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006095 }
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006096 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(dcl)) {
Nuno Lopes5773a1b2008-12-16 22:58:26 +00006097 // Okay: we can take the address of a function.
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006098 // As above.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006099 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier() &&
6100 MD->isInstance())
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006101 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6102 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6103 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Steve Narofff633d092007-04-25 19:01:39 +00006104 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006105 }
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006106
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006107 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6108 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6109 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6110 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6111 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6112 }
6113
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006114 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006115 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006116}
6117
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006118QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006119 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6120 return Context.DependentTy;
6121
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006122 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
6123 QualType Ty = Op->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006124
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006125 // Note that per both C89 and C99, this is always legal, even if ptype is an
6126 // incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about dereferencing
6127 // a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a warning is
6128 // unlikely to catch any mistakes.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006129 if (const PointerType *PT = Ty->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006130 return PT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006131
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006132 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
Fariborz Jahanianf15d4b62009-09-03 00:43:07 +00006133 return OPT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006134
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006135 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006136 << Ty << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006137 return QualType();
Steve Naroff1926c832007-04-24 00:23:05 +00006138}
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006139
6140static inline BinaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
6141 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6142 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6143 switch (Kind) {
6144 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006145 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemD; break;
6146 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemI; break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006147 case tok::star: Opc = BinaryOperator::Mul; break;
6148 case tok::slash: Opc = BinaryOperator::Div; break;
6149 case tok::percent: Opc = BinaryOperator::Rem; break;
6150 case tok::plus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Add; break;
6151 case tok::minus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Sub; break;
6152 case tok::lessless: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shl; break;
6153 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shr; break;
6154 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::LE; break;
6155 case tok::less: Opc = BinaryOperator::LT; break;
6156 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::GE; break;
6157 case tok::greater: Opc = BinaryOperator::GT; break;
6158 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::NE; break;
6159 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::EQ; break;
6160 case tok::amp: Opc = BinaryOperator::And; break;
6161 case tok::caret: Opc = BinaryOperator::Xor; break;
6162 case tok::pipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::Or; break;
6163 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BinaryOperator::LAnd; break;
6164 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::LOr; break;
6165 case tok::equal: Opc = BinaryOperator::Assign; break;
6166 case tok::starequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::MulAssign; break;
6167 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::DivAssign; break;
6168 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::RemAssign; break;
6169 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AddAssign; break;
6170 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::SubAssign; break;
6171 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShlAssign; break;
6172 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShrAssign; break;
6173 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AndAssign; break;
6174 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::XorAssign; break;
6175 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::OrAssign; break;
6176 case tok::comma: Opc = BinaryOperator::Comma; break;
6177 }
6178 return Opc;
6179}
6180
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006181static inline UnaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
6182 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6183 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6184 switch (Kind) {
6185 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
6186 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreInc; break;
6187 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreDec; break;
6188 case tok::amp: Opc = UnaryOperator::AddrOf; break;
6189 case tok::star: Opc = UnaryOperator::Deref; break;
6190 case tok::plus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Plus; break;
6191 case tok::minus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Minus; break;
6192 case tok::tilde: Opc = UnaryOperator::Not; break;
6193 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UnaryOperator::LNot; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006194 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UnaryOperator::Real; break;
6195 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UnaryOperator::Imag; break;
Chris Lattnerd0f76512007-06-08 22:16:53 +00006196 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UnaryOperator::Extension; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006197 }
6198 return Opc;
6199}
6200
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006201/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6202/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6203/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006204Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6205 unsigned Op,
6206 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006207 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006208 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)Op;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006209 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6210 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6211 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006212
6213 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006214 case BinaryOperator::Assign:
6215 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6216 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006217 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemD:
6218 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemI:
6219 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
6220 Opc == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI);
6221 break;
6222 case BinaryOperator::Mul:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006223 case BinaryOperator::Div:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006224 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
6225 Opc == BinaryOperator::Div);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006226 break;
6227 case BinaryOperator::Rem:
6228 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6229 break;
6230 case BinaryOperator::Add:
6231 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6232 break;
6233 case BinaryOperator::Sub:
6234 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6235 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006236 case BinaryOperator::Shl:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006237 case BinaryOperator::Shr:
6238 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6239 break;
6240 case BinaryOperator::LE:
6241 case BinaryOperator::LT:
6242 case BinaryOperator::GE:
6243 case BinaryOperator::GT:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006244 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006245 break;
6246 case BinaryOperator::EQ:
6247 case BinaryOperator::NE:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006248 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006249 break;
6250 case BinaryOperator::And:
6251 case BinaryOperator::Xor:
6252 case BinaryOperator::Or:
6253 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6254 break;
6255 case BinaryOperator::LAnd:
6256 case BinaryOperator::LOr:
6257 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6258 break;
6259 case BinaryOperator::MulAssign:
6260 case BinaryOperator::DivAssign:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006261 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
6262 Opc == BinaryOperator::DivAssign);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006263 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6264 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6265 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006266 break;
6267 case BinaryOperator::RemAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006268 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6269 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6270 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6271 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006272 break;
6273 case BinaryOperator::AddAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006274 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6275 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6276 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006277 break;
6278 case BinaryOperator::SubAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006279 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6280 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6281 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006282 break;
6283 case BinaryOperator::ShlAssign:
6284 case BinaryOperator::ShrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006285 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6286 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6287 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6288 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006289 break;
6290 case BinaryOperator::AndAssign:
6291 case BinaryOperator::XorAssign:
6292 case BinaryOperator::OrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006293 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6294 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6295 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6296 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006297 break;
6298 case BinaryOperator::Comma:
6299 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6300 break;
6301 }
6302 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006303 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006304 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006305 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6306 else
6307 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006308 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6309 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006310}
6311
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006312/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6313/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006314static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6315 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006316 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6317 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6318 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006319 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006320 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6321
6322 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6323 return;
6324
6325 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6326 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6327 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006328 return;
6329 }
6330
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006331 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6332 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006333 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006334
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006335 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006336 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006337
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006338 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6339 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6340 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6341 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006342 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006343 return;
6344 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006345
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006346 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006347 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6348 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006349}
6350
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006351/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6352/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6353/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6354/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006355static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6356 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006357 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6358 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6359 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6360 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006361 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006362 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006363 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6364
6365 // Subs are not binary operators.
6366 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6367 return;
6368
6369 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6370 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006371 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6372 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006373 return;
6374
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006375 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006376 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006377 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006378 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6379 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006380 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006381 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006382 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6383 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6384 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6385 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006386 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006387 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006388 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006389 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6390 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006391 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006392 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006393 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6394 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6395 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6396 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006397}
6398
6399/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6400/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6401/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
6402static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6403 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006404 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006405 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6406}
6407
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006408// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006409Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
6410 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6411 ExprArg LHS, ExprArg RHS) {
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006412 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00006413 Expr *lhs = LHS.takeAs<Expr>(), *rhs = RHS.takeAs<Expr>();
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006414
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006415 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6416 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006417
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006418 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6419 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6420
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006421 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6422}
6423
6424Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6425 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6426 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006427 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006428 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006429 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6430 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6431 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6432 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6433 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006434 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006435 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006436 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6437 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6438 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006439
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006440 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6441 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006442 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006443 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006444
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006445 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006446 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006447}
6448
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006449Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006450 unsigned OpcIn,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006451 ExprArg InputArg) {
6452 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006453
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006454 // FIXME: Input is modified below, but InputArg is not updated appropriately.
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006455 Expr *Input = (Expr *)InputArg.get();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006456 QualType resultType;
6457 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006458 case UnaryOperator::OffsetOf:
6459 assert(false && "Invalid unary operator");
6460 break;
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006461
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006462 case UnaryOperator::PreInc:
6463 case UnaryOperator::PreDec:
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006464 case UnaryOperator::PostInc:
6465 case UnaryOperator::PostDec:
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006466 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006467 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006468 Opc == UnaryOperator::PostInc,
6469 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
6470 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreDec);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006471 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006472 case UnaryOperator::AddrOf:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006473 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006474 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006475 case UnaryOperator::Deref:
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006476 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006477 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006478 break;
6479 case UnaryOperator::Plus:
6480 case UnaryOperator::Minus:
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006481 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6482 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006483 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6484 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006485 if (resultType->isArithmeticType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6486 break;
6487 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6488 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6489 break;
6490 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
6491 Opc == UnaryOperator::Plus &&
6492 resultType->isPointerType())
6493 break;
6494
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006495 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6496 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006497 case UnaryOperator::Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006498 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6499 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006500 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6501 break;
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006502 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6503 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6504 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006505 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006506 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006507 else if (!resultType->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006508 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6509 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006510 break;
6511 case UnaryOperator::LNot: // logical negation
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00006512 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006513 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006514 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006515 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6516 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006517 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006518 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6519 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattnerbe31ed82007-06-02 19:11:33 +00006520 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006521 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6522 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006523 break;
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006524 case UnaryOperator::Real:
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006525 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00006526 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UnaryOperator::Real);
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006527 break;
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006528 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006529 resultType = Input->getType();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00006530 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006531 }
6532 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006533 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006534
6535 InputArg.release();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006536 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006537}
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006538
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006539Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6540 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6541 ExprArg input) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006542 Expr *Input = (Expr*)input.get();
Anders Carlsson461a2c02009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006543 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
6544 Opc != UnaryOperator::Extension) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006545 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6546 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6547 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6548 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006549 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006550 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006551 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6552 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6553 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006554
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006555 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, move(input));
6556 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006557
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006558 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, move(input));
6559}
6560
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006561// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
6562Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6563 tok::TokenKind Op, ExprArg input) {
6564 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), move(input));
6565}
6566
Steve Naroff66356bd2007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006567/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006568Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6569 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6570 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006571 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
Chris Lattner3318e862009-04-18 20:01:55 +00006572 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getLabelMap()[LabelII];
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006573
Daniel Dunbar88402ce2008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006574 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6575 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroff846b1ec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006576 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006577 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006578
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006579 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006580 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6581 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006582}
6583
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006584Sema::OwningExprResult
6585Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, StmtArg substmt,
6586 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
6587 Stmt *SubStmt = static_cast<Stmt*>(substmt.get());
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006588 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6589 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6590
Douglas Gregor6cf3f3c2010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006591 bool isFileScope
6592 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattnera69b0762009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006593 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006594 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedman52cc0162009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006595
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006596 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6597 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6598 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006599
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006600 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6601 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6602 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006603
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006604 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6605 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6606 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6607 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6608 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006609
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006610 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006611 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006612 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006613
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006614 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6615 // expressions are not lvalues.
6616
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006617 substmt.release();
6618 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006619}
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006620
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006621Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6622 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006623 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6624 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006625 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6626 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006627 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006628 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange();
6629
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006630 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6631 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6632 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006633 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006634 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6635 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6636
6637 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6638 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6639 if (!Dependent
6640 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6641 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6642 << TypeRange))
6643 return ExprError();
6644
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006645 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6646 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006647 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6648 // a system header!
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006649 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006650 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6651 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006652
6653 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
6654 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
6655 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
6656 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
6657 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
6658 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6659 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6660 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6661 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6662 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6663 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
6664 if(!AT)
6665 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
6666 << CurrentType);
6667 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
6668 } else
6669 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6670
6671 // The expression must be an integral expression.
6672 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
6673 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
6674 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
6675 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
6676 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
6677 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
6678 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6679
6680 // Record this array index.
6681 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
6682 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
6683 continue;
6684 }
6685
6686 // Offset of a field.
6687 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6688 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
6689 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
6690 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
6691 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6692 continue;
6693 }
6694
6695 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
6696 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
6697 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6698 return ExprError();
6699
6700 // Look for the designated field.
6701 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
6702 if (!RC)
6703 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6704 << CurrentType);
6705 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
6706
6707 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
6708 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
6709 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
6710 // (clause 9).
6711 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
6712 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6713 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6714 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
6715 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6716 << CurrentType))
6717 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
6718 }
6719
6720 // Look for the field.
6721 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6722 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
6723 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
6724 if (!MemberDecl)
6725 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
6726 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
6727 OC.LocEnd));
6728
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006729 // C99 7.17p3:
6730 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6731 //
6732 // We diagnose this as an error.
6733 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6734 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6735 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6736 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
6737 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6738 return ExprError();
6739 }
6740
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00006741 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
6742 // the base class indirections.
6743 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
6744 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
6745 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType,
6746 Context.getTypeDeclType(MemberDecl->getParent()),
6747 Paths)) {
6748 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
6749 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
6750 B != BEnd; ++B)
6751 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
6752 }
6753
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006754 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006755 isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006756 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
6757 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
6758 unsigned n = Path.size();
6759 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
6760 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
6761 } else {
6762 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
6763 }
6764 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
6765 }
6766
6767 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
6768 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
6769 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
6770}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006771
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006772Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
6773 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6774 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
6775 TypeTy *argty,
6776 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6777 unsigned NumComponents,
6778 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6779
6780 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
6781 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
6782 if (ArgTy.isNull())
6783 return ExprError();
6784
6785 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6786 if (!ArgTInfo)
6787 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
6788
6789 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
6790 RPLoc);
6791 }
6792
6793 // FIXME: The code below is marked for death, once we have proper CodeGen
6794 // support for non-constant OffsetOf expressions.
6795
6796 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
6797
6798 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6799 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6800 // a struct/union/class.
6801 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
6802 return ExprError(Diag(TypeLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) << ArgTy);
6803
6804 // FIXME: Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6805 // with an incomplete type would be illegal.
6806
6807 // Otherwise, create a null pointer as the base, and iteratively process
6808 // the offsetof designators.
6809 QualType ArgTyPtr = Context.getPointerType(ArgTy);
6810 Expr* Res = new (Context) ImplicitValueInitExpr(ArgTyPtr);
6811 Res = new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::Deref,
6812 ArgTy, SourceLocation());
6813
6814 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6815 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
6816 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6817 // a system header!
6818 if (NumComponents != 1)
6819 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6820 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
6821
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006822 if (!Dependent) {
Eli Friedman8469bc72009-05-03 21:22:18 +00006823 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006824
John McCall9eff4e62009-11-04 03:03:43 +00006825 if (RequireCompleteType(TypeLoc, Res->getType(),
6826 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6827 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006828
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006829 // FIXME: Dependent case loses a lot of information here. And probably
6830 // leaks like a sieve.
6831 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6832 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6833 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6834 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6835 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(Res->getType());
6836 if (!AT) {
6837 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006838 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006839 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006840 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006841
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006842 // FIXME: C++: Verify that operator[] isn't overloaded.
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006843
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006844 // Promote the array so it looks more like a normal array subscript
6845 // expression.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006846 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Res);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006847
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006848 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
6849 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006850 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006851 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006852 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00006853 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006854 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6855
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006856 Res = new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(Res, Idx, AT->getElementType(),
6857 OC.LocEnd);
6858 continue;
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006859 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006860
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006861 const RecordType *RC = Res->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006862 if (!RC) {
6863 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006864 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006865 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006866 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006867
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006868 // Get the decl corresponding to this.
6869 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
Anders Carlsson2bbb86b2009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006870 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00006871 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6872 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6873 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006874 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6875 << Res->getType()))
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00006876 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
Anders Carlsson2bbb86b2009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006877 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006878
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00006879 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6880 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006881
John McCall67c00872009-12-02 08:25:40 +00006882 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006883 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006884 if (!MemberDecl)
Douglas Gregore40876a2009-10-13 21:16:44 +00006885 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006886 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart, OC.LocEnd));
6887
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006888 // C99 7.17p3:
6889 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6890 //
6891 // We diagnose this as an error.
6892 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6893 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6894 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6895 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
6896 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6897 return ExprError();
6898 }
6899
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006900 // FIXME: C++: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a static field.
6901 // FIXME: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a bitfield.
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006902 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Anders Carlsson3cbc8592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00006903 Res = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006904 OC.LocEnd, MemberDecl, Res, OC.LocEnd).takeAs<Expr>();
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006905 } else {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006906 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Res, /*Qualifier=*/0,
6907 *R.begin(), MemberDecl);
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006908 // MemberDecl->getType() doesn't get the right qualifiers, but it
6909 // doesn't matter here.
6910 Res = new (Context) MemberExpr(Res, false, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006911 MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType());
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006912 }
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006913 }
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006914 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006915
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006916 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::OffsetOf,
6917 Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc));
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006918}
6919
6920
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006921Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6922 TypeTy *arg1,TypeTy *arg2,
6923 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc7148c92009-08-19 01:28:28 +00006924 // FIXME: Preserve type source info.
6925 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1);
6926 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006927
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006928 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006929
Douglas Gregorf907cbf2009-05-19 22:28:02 +00006930 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6931 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
6932 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
6933 return ExprError();
6934 }
6935
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006936 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
6937 argT1, argT2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006938}
6939
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006940Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6941 ExprArg cond,
6942 ExprArg expr1, ExprArg expr2,
6943 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6944 Expr *CondExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(cond.get());
6945 Expr *LHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr1.get());
6946 Expr *RHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr2.get());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006947
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006948 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
6949
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006950 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006951 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregor0df91122009-05-19 22:43:30 +00006952 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006953 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006954 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006955 } else {
6956 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
6957 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
6958 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
6959 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006960 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
6961 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
6962 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006963
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006964 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
6965 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006966 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
6967 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006968 }
6969
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006970 cond.release(); expr1.release(); expr2.release();
6971 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006972 resType, RPLoc,
6973 resType->isDependentType(),
6974 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006975}
6976
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006977//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6978// Clang Extensions.
6979//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6980
6981/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006982void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00006983 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
6984 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
6985 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
6986 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006987}
6988
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006989void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00006990 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00006991 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006992
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006993 if (ParamInfo.getNumTypeObjects() == 0
6994 || ParamInfo.getTypeObject(0).Kind != DeclaratorChunk::Function) {
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00006995 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006996 QualType T = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
6997
Mike Stumpd456c482009-04-28 01:10:27 +00006998 if (T->isArrayType()) {
6999 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7000 diag::err_block_returns_array);
7001 return;
7002 }
7003
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007004 // The parameter list is optional, if there was none, assume ().
7005 if (!T->isFunctionType())
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00007006 T = Context.getFunctionType(T, 0, 0, false, 0, false, false, 0, 0,
7007 FunctionType::ExtInfo());
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007008
7009 CurBlock->hasPrototype = true;
7010 CurBlock->isVariadic = false;
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00007011 // Check for a valid sentinel attribute on this block.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00007012 if (CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007013 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
Fariborz Jahanian6802ed92009-05-15 21:18:04 +00007014 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00007015 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7016 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007017 QualType RetTy = T.getTypePtr()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getResultType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007018
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007019 // Do not allow returning a objc interface by-value.
7020 if (RetTy->isObjCInterfaceType()) {
7021 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7022 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7023 return;
7024 }
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007025
7026 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007027 return;
7028 }
7029
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007030 // Analyze arguments to block.
7031 assert(ParamInfo.getTypeObject(0).Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Function &&
7032 "Not a function declarator!");
7033 DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = ParamInfo.getTypeObject(0).Fun;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007034
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007035 CurBlock->hasPrototype = FTI.hasPrototype;
7036 CurBlock->isVariadic = true;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007037
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007038 // Check for C99 6.7.5.3p10 - foo(void) is a non-varargs function that takes
7039 // no arguments, not a function that takes a single void argument.
7040 if (FTI.hasPrototype &&
7041 FTI.NumArgs == 1 && !FTI.isVariadic && FTI.ArgInfo[0].Ident == 0 &&
Chris Lattner83f095c2009-03-28 19:18:32 +00007042 (!FTI.ArgInfo[0].Param.getAs<ParmVarDecl>()->getType().getCVRQualifiers()&&
7043 FTI.ArgInfo[0].Param.getAs<ParmVarDecl>()->getType()->isVoidType())) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007044 // empty arg list, don't push any params.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007045 CurBlock->isVariadic = false;
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007046 } else if (FTI.hasPrototype) {
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007047 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FTI.NumArgs; i != e; ++i) {
7048 ParmVarDecl *Param = FTI.ArgInfo[i].Param.getAs<ParmVarDecl>();
7049 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7050 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7051 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7052 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7053 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
7054 CurBlock->Params.push_back(Param);
7055 }
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007056 CurBlock->isVariadic = FTI.isVariadic;
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007057 }
Douglas Gregord5058122010-02-11 01:19:42 +00007058 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(CurBlock->Params.data(),
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007059 CurBlock->Params.size());
Fariborz Jahanian960910a2009-05-19 17:08:59 +00007060 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(CurBlock->isVariadic);
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007061 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007062
7063 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7064 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7065
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007066 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007067 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7068 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7069
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007070 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007071 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7072 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7073 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7074
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007075 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007076 }
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007077 }
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007078
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00007079 // Check for a valid sentinel attribute on this block.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007080 if (!CurBlock->isVariadic &&
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00007081 CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007082 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
Fariborz Jahanian6802ed92009-05-15 21:18:04 +00007083 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00007084 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7085 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007086
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007087 // Analyze the return type.
7088 QualType T = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007089 QualType RetTy = T->getAs<FunctionType>()->getResultType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007090
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007091 // Do not allow returning a objc interface by-value.
7092 if (RetTy->isObjCInterfaceType()) {
7093 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7094 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7095 } else if (!RetTy->isDependentType())
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007096 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007097}
7098
7099/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7100/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7101void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007102 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner41b86942009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007103 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007104 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007105 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007106}
7107
7108/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7109/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007110Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
7111 StmtArg body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9eac9312009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007112 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7113 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7114 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007115
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007116 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007117
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007118 PopDeclContext();
7119
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007120 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007121 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7122 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007123
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007124 llvm::SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
7125 for (unsigned i = 0, e = BSI->Params.size(); i != e; ++i)
7126 ArgTypes.push_back(BSI->Params[i]->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007127
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007128 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007129 QualType BlockTy;
7130 if (!BSI->hasPrototype)
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007131 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0, false, false, 0, 0,
Rafael Espindola49b85ab2010-03-30 22:15:11 +00007132 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007133 else
Jay Foad7d0479f2009-05-21 09:52:38 +00007134 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, ArgTypes.data(), ArgTypes.size(),
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007135 BSI->isVariadic, 0, false, false, 0, 0,
Rafael Espindola49b85ab2010-03-30 22:15:11 +00007136 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007137
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007138 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007139 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->Params.begin(), BSI->Params.end());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007140 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007141
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007142 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007143 if (FunctionNeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007144 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(static_cast<CompoundStmt*>(body.get()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007145
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00007146 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(body.takeAs<CompoundStmt>());
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007147
7148 bool Good = true;
7149 // Check goto/label use.
7150 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7151 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7152 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7153
7154 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7155 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
7156 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0)
7157 continue;
7158
7159 // Emit error.
7160 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7161 Good = false;
7162 }
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007163 if (!Good) {
7164 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007165 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007166 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007167
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007168 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenek0b405322010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007169 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7170 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
7171 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy);
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007172
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007173 Expr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7174 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007175 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007176 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007177}
7178
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007179Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7180 ExprArg expr, TypeTy *type,
7181 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc7148c92009-08-19 01:28:28 +00007182 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type);
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007183 Expr *E = static_cast<Expr*>(expr.get());
7184 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007185
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007186 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007187
7188 // Get the va_list type
7189 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007190 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7191 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7192 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7193 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007194 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007195 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7196 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7197 } else {
7198 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7199 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007200 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007201 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007202 return ExprError();
7203 }
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007204
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007205 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7206 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007207 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7208 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007209 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner3f5cd772009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007210 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007211
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007212 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007213 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007214
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007215 expr.release();
7216 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, T.getNonReferenceType(),
7217 RPLoc));
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007218}
7219
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007220Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007221 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7222 // pointers on the target.
7223 QualType Ty;
7224 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7225 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7226 else
7227 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7228
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007229 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007230}
7231
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007232static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007233 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007234 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7235 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007236
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007237 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7238 if (!PT)
7239 return;
7240
7241 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7242 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7243 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7244 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7245 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7246 return;
7247 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007248
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007249 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7250 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7251 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7252 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007253
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007254 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007255}
7256
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007257bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7258 SourceLocation Loc,
7259 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007260 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7261 bool *Complained) {
7262 if (Complained)
7263 *Complained = false;
7264
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007265 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7266 bool isInvalid = false;
7267 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007268 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007269
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007270 switch (ConvTy) {
7271 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7272 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007273 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007274 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7275 break;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007276 case IntToPointer:
7277 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7278 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007279 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007280 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007281 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7282 break;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007283 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7284 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7285 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007286 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7287 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7288 break;
7289 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007290 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7291 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7292 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7293 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7294 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7295 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7296 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7297 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7298 // C++ semantics.
7299 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7300 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7301 return false;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007302 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7303 break;
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007304 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanianb98dade2009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007305 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007306 break;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007307 case IntToBlockPointer:
7308 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7309 break;
7310 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stumpd79b5a82009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007311 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007312 break;
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007313 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007314 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007315 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7316 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7317 break;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007318 case IncompatibleVectors:
7319 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7320 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007321 case Incompatible:
7322 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7323 isInvalid = true;
7324 break;
7325 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007326
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007327 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7328 switch (Action) {
7329 case AA_Assigning:
7330 case AA_Initializing:
7331 // The destination type comes first.
7332 FirstType = DstType;
7333 SecondType = SrcType;
7334 break;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007335
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007336 case AA_Returning:
7337 case AA_Passing:
7338 case AA_Converting:
7339 case AA_Sending:
7340 case AA_Casting:
7341 // The source type comes first.
7342 FirstType = SrcType;
7343 SecondType = DstType;
7344 break;
7345 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007346
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007347 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007348 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007349 if (Complained)
7350 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007351 return isInvalid;
7352}
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007353
Chris Lattnerc71d08b2009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007354bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007355 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7356 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7357 if (Result)
7358 *Result = ICEResult;
7359 return false;
7360 }
7361
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007362 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7363
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007364 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007365 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7366 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7367
7368 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7369 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7370 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7371 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7372 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7373 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7374 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007375
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007376 return true;
7377 }
7378
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007379 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7380 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007381
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007382 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7383 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7384 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007385
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007386 if (Result)
7387 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7388 return false;
7389}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007390
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007391void
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007392Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007393 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7394 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007395}
7396
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007397void
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007398Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7399 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7400 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7401 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007402
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007403 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7404 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7405 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7406 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7407 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007408 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007409 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7410 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7411 I != IEnd; ++I)
7412 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7413 }
7414
7415 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7416 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7417 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7418 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7419 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7420 I != IEnd; ++I)
7421 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7422 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007423 }
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007424
7425 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7426 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7427 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7428 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007429 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007430 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7431 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7432 ExprTemporaries.end());
7433
7434 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7435 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007436}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007437
7438/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7439///
7440/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7441/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7442/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7443/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7444///
7445/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7446///
7447/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7448void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7449 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007450
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007451 if (D->isUsed())
7452 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007453
Douglas Gregor3beaf9b2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007454 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7455 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7456 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7457 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007458 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007459 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007460 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007461 return;
7462 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007463
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007464 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7465 return;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007466
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007467 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7468 // an instantiation.
7469 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7470 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007471
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007472 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007473 case Unevaluated:
7474 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7475 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007476
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007477 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7478 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7479 // "used"; handle this below.
7480 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007481
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007482 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7483 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7484 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7485 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007486 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007487 return;
7488 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007489
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007490 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanian3a363432009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007491 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007492 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007493 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
7494 if (!Constructor->isUsed())
7495 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007496 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007497 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007498 if (!Constructor->isUsed())
7499 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7500 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007501
Anders Carlsson82fccd02009-12-07 08:24:59 +00007502 MaybeMarkVirtualMembersReferenced(Loc, Constructor);
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007503 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
7504 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed())
7505 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007506
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007507 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7508 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7509 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
7510 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed())
Douglas Gregora57478e2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007511 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007512 }
7513 }
Fariborz Jahanian49796cc72009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007514 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007515 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor4adbc6d2009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007516 // class templates.
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007517 if (!Function->getBody() && Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007518 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7519 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7520 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7521 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7522 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007523 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007524 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007525 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007526 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007527 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7528 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7529 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007530 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007531 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007532 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7533 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007534
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007535 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7536 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7537 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7538 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7539 Loc));
7540 else
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007541 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007542 Loc));
7543 }
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007544 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007545
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007546 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007547 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007548
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007549 return;
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007550 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007551
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007552 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007553 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007554 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007555 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7556 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7557 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7558 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7559 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7560 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
7561 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
7562 }
7563 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007564
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007565 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007566
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007567 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007568 return;
Sam Weinigbae69142009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007569 }
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007570}
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007571
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007572/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7573/// of the program being compiled.
7574///
7575/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007576/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007577/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7578/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7579/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7580/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007581/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007582/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007583///
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007584/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7585/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7586/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7587/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007588bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007589 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7590 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7591 case Unevaluated:
7592 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7593 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007594
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007595 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7596 Diag(Loc, PD);
7597 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007598
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007599 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7600 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7601 break;
7602 }
7603
7604 return false;
7605}
7606
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007607bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7608 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7609 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7610 return false;
7611
7612 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7613 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7614 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7615 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007616
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007617 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007618 FD ?
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007619 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7620 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007621 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007622 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7623 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7624 return true;
7625
7626 return false;
7627}
7628
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007629// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
7630// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
7631void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
7632 SourceLocation Loc;
7633
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007634 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
7635
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007636 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
7637 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
7638 if (Op->getOpcode() != BinaryOperator::Assign)
7639 return;
7640
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007641 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
7642 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
7643 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
7644 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
7645
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007646 // self = [<foo> init...]
7647 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
7648 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
7649 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7650
7651 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
7652 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
7653 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
7654 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7655 }
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007656
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007657 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7658 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
7659 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
7660 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
7661 return;
7662
7663 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7664 } else {
7665 // Not an assignment.
7666 return;
7667 }
7668
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007669 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCalle724ae92009-10-12 22:25:59 +00007670 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007671
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007672 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007673 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007674 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007675 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
7676 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
7677 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007678}
7679
7680bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7681 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
7682
7683 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007684 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007685
7686 QualType T = E->getType();
7687
7688 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7689 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
7690 return true;
7691 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
7692 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
7693 << T << E->getSourceRange();
7694 return true;
7695 }
7696 }
7697
7698 return false;
7699}
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007700
7701Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
7702 ExprArg SubExpr) {
Douglas Gregor12cc7ee2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00007703 Expr *Sub = SubExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
7704 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007705 return ExprError();
7706
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007707 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc)) {
7708 Sub->Destroy(Context);
7709 return ExprError();
7710 }
7711
7712 return Owned(Sub);
7713}